diff options
68 files changed, 1288 insertions, 8015 deletions
@@ -15,6 +15,7 @@ INSTALL depcomp missing install-sh +mkinstalldirs autom4te*.cache configure.lineno configure diff --git a/bgpd/Makefile.am b/bgpd/Makefile.am index 1b17d386..56a9fb8f 100644 --- a/bgpd/Makefile.am +++ b/bgpd/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,6 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 AM_CFLAGS = $(PICFLAGS) diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_attr.c b/bgpd/bgp_attr.c index 5e7536ae..2de60031 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_attr.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_attr.c @@ -2353,7 +2353,7 @@ bgp_attr_finish (void) /* Make attribute packet. */ void bgp_dump_routes_attr (struct stream *s, struct attr *attr, - struct prefix *prefix) + struct prefix *prefix, uint16_t flags) { unsigned long cp; unsigned long len; @@ -2494,6 +2494,14 @@ bgp_dump_routes_attr (struct stream *s, struct attr *attr, stream_putl (s, attr->pathlimit.as); } + /* Quagga extended dump attribute. */ + stream_putc (s, BGP_ATTR_FLAG_OPTIONAL); + stream_putc (s, BGP_ATTR_QUAGGA_DUMPEXT); + stream_putc (s, 3); + /* put a version byte to allow clean extensions */ + stream_putc (s, 0); + stream_putw (s, flags); + /* Return total size of attribute. */ len = stream_get_endp (s) - cp - 2; stream_putw_at (s, cp, len); diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_attr.h b/bgpd/bgp_attr.h index ed8753bd..a09ed61c 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_attr.h +++ b/bgpd/bgp_attr.h @@ -163,7 +163,7 @@ extern bgp_size_t bgp_packet_withdraw (struct peer *peer, struct stream *s, struct prefix *p, afi_t, safi_t, struct prefix_rd *, u_char *); extern void bgp_dump_routes_attr (struct stream *, struct attr *, - struct prefix *); + struct prefix *, uint16_t); extern int attrhash_cmp (const void *, const void *); extern unsigned int attrhash_key_make (void *); extern void attr_show_all (struct vty *); diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_dump.c b/bgpd/bgp_dump.c index 8087a403..2f5c83af 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_dump.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_dump.c @@ -199,6 +199,7 @@ bgp_dump_routes_index_table(struct bgp *bgp) struct listnode *node; uint16_t peerno = 0; struct stream *obuf; + struct in_addr localhost = { htonl(INADDR_LOOPBACK) }; obuf = bgp_dump_obuf; stream_reset (obuf); @@ -221,8 +222,15 @@ bgp_dump_routes_index_table(struct bgp *bgp) } /* Peer count */ - stream_putw (obuf, listcount(bgp->peer)); + stream_putw (obuf, listcount(bgp->peer) + 1); + /* Peer #0 entry reflects locally originated routes */ + stream_putc (obuf, TABLE_DUMP_V2_PEER_INDEX_TABLE_AS4+TABLE_DUMP_V2_PEER_INDEX_TABLE_IP); + stream_put_in_addr (obuf, &bgp->router_id); + stream_put_in_addr (obuf, &localhost); + stream_putl (obuf, bgp->as); + + peerno++; /* Walk down all peers */ for(ALL_LIST_ELEMENTS_RO (bgp->peer, node, peer)) { @@ -360,7 +368,7 @@ bgp_dump_routes_func (int afi, int first_run, unsigned int seq) /* Dump attribute. */ /* Skip prefix & AFI/SAFI for MP_NLRI */ - bgp_dump_routes_attr (obuf, info->attr, &rn->p); + bgp_dump_routes_attr (obuf, info->attr, &rn->p, info->flags); } /* Overwrite the entry count, now that we know the right number */ diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_main.c b/bgpd/bgp_main.c index 9d14683c..f761f238 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_main.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_main.c @@ -35,6 +35,7 @@ Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA #include "routemap.h" #include "filter.h" #include "plist.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "bgpd/bgpd.h" #include "bgpd/bgp_attr.h" @@ -52,6 +53,7 @@ Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA static const struct option longopts[] = { { "daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, { "pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, { "bgp_port", required_argument, NULL, 'p'}, @@ -96,7 +98,7 @@ static struct quagga_signal_t bgp_signals[] = }; /* Configuration file and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR BGP_DEFAULT_CONFIG; +static char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; /* Route retain mode flag. */ static int retain_mode = 0; @@ -107,8 +109,11 @@ struct thread_master *master; /* Manually specified configuration file name. */ char *config_file = NULL; +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -static const char *pid_file = PATH_BGPD_PID; +static const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* VTY port number and address. */ int vty_port = BGP_VTY_PORT; @@ -147,6 +152,7 @@ usage (char *progname, int status) Daemon which manages kernel routing table management and \ redistribution between different routing protocols.\n\n\ -d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n\ +-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n\ -f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n\ -i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n\ -p, --bgp_port Set bgp protocol's port number\n\ @@ -182,7 +188,7 @@ sighup (void) vty_read_config (config_file, config_default); /* Create VTY's socket */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, BGP_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (BGP_VTY_NAME)); /* Try to return to normal operation. */ } @@ -327,7 +333,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) /* Command line argument treatment. */ while (1) { - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "df:i:hp:l:A:P:rnu:g:vC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "dN:f:i:hp:l:A:P:rnu:g:vC", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -339,6 +345,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'f': config_file = optarg; break; @@ -398,6 +407,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (BGP_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (BGP_PID_NAME)); + /* Make thread master. */ master = bm->master; @@ -434,7 +446,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) pid_output (pid_file); /* Make bgp vty socket. */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, BGP_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (BGP_VTY_NAME)); /* Print banner. */ zlog_notice ("BGPd %s starting: vty@%d, bgp@%s:%d", QUAGGA_VERSION, diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_network.c b/bgpd/bgp_network.c index 9e3427d2..1a8587e9 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_network.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_network.c @@ -383,14 +383,7 @@ bgp_listener (int sock, struct sockaddr *sa, socklen_t salen) setsockopt_ipv4_tos (sock, IPTOS_PREC_INTERNETCONTROL); #endif -#ifdef IPV6_V6ONLY - /* Want only IPV6 on ipv6 socket (not mapped addresses) */ - if (sa->sa_family == AF_INET6) { - int on = 1; - setsockopt (sock, IPPROTO_IPV6, IPV6_V6ONLY, - (void *) &on, sizeof (on)); - } -#endif + sockopt_v6only (sa->sa_family, sock); if (bgpd_privs.change (ZPRIVS_RAISE) ) zlog_err ("bgp_socket: could not raise privs"); diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_nexthop.c b/bgpd/bgp_nexthop.c index 0cde665e..ba6f6ffa 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_nexthop.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_nexthop.c @@ -28,6 +28,7 @@ Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA #include "network.h" #include "log.h" #include "memory.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "bgpd/bgpd.h" #include "bgpd/bgp_table.h" @@ -1097,7 +1098,7 @@ zlookup_connect (struct thread *t) #ifdef HAVE_TCP_ZEBRA zlookup->sock = zclient_socket (); #else - zlookup->sock = zclient_socket_un (ZEBRA_SERV_PATH); + zlookup->sock = zclient_socket_un (path_state (ZEBRA_SERV_NAME)); #endif /* HAVE_TCP_ZEBRA */ if (zlookup->sock < 0) return -1; diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_route.c b/bgpd/bgp_route.c index a92ca4e2..0bc9ad8a 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_route.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_route.c @@ -5613,23 +5613,7 @@ route_vty_out_route (struct prefix *p, struct vty *vty) u_int32_t destination; char buf[BUFSIZ]; - if (p->family == AF_INET) - { - len = vty_out (vty, "%s", inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, BUFSIZ)); - destination = ntohl (p->u.prefix4.s_addr); - - if ((IN_CLASSC (destination) && p->prefixlen == 24) - || (IN_CLASSB (destination) && p->prefixlen == 16) - || (IN_CLASSA (destination) && p->prefixlen == 8) - || p->u.prefix4.s_addr == 0) - { - /* When mask is natural, mask is not displayed. */ - } - else - len += vty_out (vty, "/%d", p->prefixlen); - } - else - len = vty_out (vty, "%s/%d", inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, BUFSIZ), + len = vty_out (vty, "%s/%d", inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, BUFSIZ), p->prefixlen); len = 17 - len; @@ -11521,18 +11505,9 @@ bgp_config_write_network (struct vty *vty, struct bgp *bgp, destination = ntohl (p->u.prefix4.s_addr); masklen2ip (p->prefixlen, &netmask); - vty_out (vty, " network %s", - inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, SU_ADDRSTRLEN)); - - if ((IN_CLASSC (destination) && p->prefixlen == 24) - || (IN_CLASSB (destination) && p->prefixlen == 16) - || (IN_CLASSA (destination) && p->prefixlen == 8) - || p->u.prefix4.s_addr == 0) - { - /* Natural mask is not display. */ - } - else - vty_out (vty, " mask %s", inet_ntoa (netmask)); + vty_out (vty, " network %s mask %s", + inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, SU_ADDRSTRLEN), + inet_ntoa (netmask)); } else { diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_vty.c b/bgpd/bgp_vty.c index 88be52e2..c442baab 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_vty.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_vty.c @@ -8210,57 +8210,16 @@ ALIAS (show_bgp_instance_rsclient_summary, /* Redistribute VTY commands. */ -/* Utility function to convert user input route type string to route - type. */ -static int -bgp_str2route_type (int afi, const char *str) -{ - if (! str) - return 0; - - if (afi == AFI_IP) - { - if (strncmp (str, "k", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (str, "c", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (str, "s", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else if (strncmp (str, "r", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP; - else if (strncmp (str, "o", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF; - } - if (afi == AFI_IP6) - { - if (strncmp (str, "k", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (str, "c", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (str, "s", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else if (strncmp (str, "r", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG; - else if (strncmp (str, "o", 1) == 0) - return ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6; - } - return 0; -} - DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4, bgp_redistribute_ipv4_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static)", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD, "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n") + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD) { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8270,20 +8229,16 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap, bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) route-map WORD", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n") { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8295,21 +8250,17 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric, bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) metric <0-4294967295>", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295>", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n") { int type; u_int32_t metric; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8322,13 +8273,9 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n" "Metric for redistributed routes\n" @@ -8337,8 +8284,8 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, int type; u_int32_t metric; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8352,13 +8299,9 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_rmap, bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_rmap_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n" "Route map reference\n" @@ -8367,8 +8310,8 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_rmap, int type; u_int32_t metric; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8382,19 +8325,15 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_rmap, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static)", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD, NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n") + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD) { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8405,21 +8344,17 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) route-map WORD", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n") { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8431,21 +8366,17 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) metric <0-4294967295>", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295>", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n") { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8457,14 +8388,10 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n" "Metric for redistributed routes\n" @@ -8472,8 +8399,8 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8486,14 +8413,10 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, ALIAS (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_metric_rmap_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf|rip|static) metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n" "Route map reference\n" @@ -8502,18 +8425,14 @@ ALIAS (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv4_rmap_metric, #ifdef HAVE_IPV6 DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6, bgp_redistribute_ipv6_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static)", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD, "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n") + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD) { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8524,20 +8443,16 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap, bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) route-map WORD", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n") { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8549,21 +8464,17 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric, bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) metric <0-4294967295>", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295>", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n") { int type; u_int32_t metric; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8576,13 +8487,9 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n" "Metric for redistributed routes\n" @@ -8591,8 +8498,8 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, int type; u_int32_t metric; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8606,13 +8513,9 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_rmap, bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_rmap_cmd, - "redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n" "Route map reference\n" @@ -8621,8 +8524,8 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_rmap, int type; u_int32_t metric; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8636,19 +8539,15 @@ DEFUN (bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_rmap, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static)", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD, NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n") + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD) { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8659,21 +8558,17 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) route-map WORD", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n") { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8685,21 +8580,17 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) metric <0-4294967295>", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295>", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n") { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8711,14 +8602,10 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric, DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " route-map WORD metric <0-4294967295>", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Route map reference\n" "Pointer to route-map entries\n" "Metric for redistributed routes\n" @@ -8726,8 +8613,8 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, { int type; - type = bgp_str2route_type (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); - if (! type) + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP) { vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -8740,14 +8627,10 @@ DEFUN (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, ALIAS (no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_rmap_metric, no_bgp_redistribute_ipv6_metric_rmap_cmd, - "no redistribute (connected|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static) metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_BGPD " metric <0-4294967295> route-map WORD", NO_STR "Redistribute information from another routing protocol\n" - "Connected\n" - "Kernel routes\n" - "Open Shurtest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n" + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_BGPD "Metric for redistributed routes\n" "Default metric\n" "Route map reference\n" diff --git a/bgpd/bgp_zebra.c b/bgpd/bgp_zebra.c index f3baeee0..d4f95745 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgp_zebra.c +++ b/bgpd/bgp_zebra.c @@ -432,6 +432,28 @@ if_lookup_by_ipv4_exact (struct in_addr *addr) return NULL; } +static int +if_get_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, struct in_addr *addr) +{ + struct listnode *cnode; + struct connected *connected; + struct prefix *cp; + int hit = 0; + + for (ALL_LIST_ELEMENTS_RO (ifp->connected, cnode, connected)) + { + cp = connected->address; + + if (cp->family == AF_INET) + if (!hit || ntohl(cp->u.prefix4.s_addr) < ntohl(addr->s_addr)) + { + memcpy (addr, &cp->u.prefix4, IPV4_MAX_BYTELEN); + hit = 1; + } + } + return hit; +} + #ifdef HAVE_IPV6 struct interface * if_lookup_by_ipv6 (struct in6_addr *addr) @@ -586,7 +608,8 @@ bgp_nexthop_set (union sockunion *local, union sockunion *remote, struct interface *direct = NULL; /* IPv4 nexthop. I don't care about it. */ - if (peer->local_id.s_addr) + ret = if_get_ipv4 (ifp, &nexthop->v4); + if (!ret && peer->local_id.s_addr) nexthop->v4 = peer->local_id; /* Global address*/ diff --git a/bgpd/bgpd.h b/bgpd/bgpd.h index a5afaedc..77c26646 100644 --- a/bgpd/bgpd.h +++ b/bgpd/bgpd.h @@ -616,6 +616,9 @@ struct bgp_nlri #define BGP_ATTR_AS4_AGGREGATOR 18 #define BGP_ATTR_AS_PATHLIMIT 21 +/* BGP attribute 255, "development". Used in dumps for extended information. */ +#define BGP_ATTR_QUAGGA_DUMPEXT 255 + /* BGP update origin. */ #define BGP_ORIGIN_IGP 0 #define BGP_ORIGIN_EGP 1 @@ -736,7 +739,9 @@ struct bgp_nlri /* Default configuration settings for bgpd. */ #define BGP_VTY_PORT 2605 -#define BGP_DEFAULT_CONFIG "bgpd.conf" +#define BGP_CONFIG_NAME "bgpd.conf" +#define BGP_PID_NAME "bgpd.pid" +#define BGP_VTY_NAME "bgpd.vty" /* Check AS path loop when we send NLRI. */ /* #define BGP_SEND_ASPATH_CHECK */ diff --git a/configure.ac b/configure.ac index 9c47b5b4..9388403f 100755 --- a/configure.ac +++ b/configure.ac @@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ ## $Id$ AC_PREREQ(2.53) -AC_INIT(Quagga, 0.99.15, [http://bugzilla.quagga.net]) +AC_INIT(Quagga, [1.1.0-dn42.11], [http://bugzilla.quagga.net]) AC_CONFIG_SRCDIR(lib/zebra.h) AC_CONFIG_MACRO_DIR([m4]) @@ -666,11 +666,9 @@ dnl ---------------------------- AC_FUNC_CHOWN AC_FUNC_FNMATCH AC_FUNC_FORK -AC_FUNC_MALLOC AC_FUNC_MEMCMP AC_FUNC_MKTIME AC_FUNC_STRFTIME -AC_FUNC_REALLOC AC_FUNC_STAT AC_FUNC_SELECT_ARGTYPES AC_FUNC_STRFTIME @@ -970,10 +968,18 @@ dnl ----------------------------- dnl check ipforward detect method dnl ----------------------------- AC_CACHE_CHECK([ipforward method], [quagga_cv_ipforward_method], -[for quagga_cv_ipforward_method in /proc/net/snmp /dev/ip /dev/null; -do - test x`ls $quagga_cv_ipforward_method 2>/dev/null` = x"$quagga_cv_ipforward_method" && break -done +[if test x$cross_compiling = xyes; then + if test x"$opsys" = x"gnu-linux"; then + quagga_cv_ipforward_method=/proc/net/snmp + else + quagga_cv_ipforward_method=/dev/ip + fi +else + for quagga_cv_ipforward_method in /proc/net/snmp /dev/ip /dev/null; + do + test x`ls $quagga_cv_ipforward_method 2>/dev/null` = x"$quagga_cv_ipforward_method" && break + done +fi case $quagga_cv_ipforward_method in "/proc/net/snmp") quagga_cv_ipforward_method="proc";; "/dev/ip") @@ -1486,22 +1492,8 @@ fi AC_MSG_RESULT(${quagga_statedir}) AC_SUBST(quagga_statedir) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_ZEBRA_PID, "$quagga_statedir/zebra.pid",zebra PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_RIPD_PID, "$quagga_statedir/ripd.pid",ripd PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_RIPNGD_PID, "$quagga_statedir/ripngd.pid",ripngd PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_BGPD_PID, "$quagga_statedir/bgpd.pid",bgpd PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_OSPFD_PID, "$quagga_statedir/ospfd.pid",ospfd PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_OSPF6D_PID, "$quagga_statedir/ospf6d.pid",ospf6d PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_ISISD_PID, "$quagga_statedir/isisd.pid",isisd PID) +AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_STATE, "$quagga_statedir",zebra state path) AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PATH_WATCHQUAGGA_PID, "$quagga_statedir/watchquagga.pid",watchquagga PID) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(ZEBRA_SERV_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/zserv.api",zebra api socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(ZEBRA_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/zebra.vty",zebra vty socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(RIP_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/ripd.vty",rip vty socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(RIPNG_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/ripngd.vty",ripng vty socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(BGP_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/bgpd.vty",bgpd vty socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(OSPF_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/ospfd.vty",ospfd vty socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(OSPF6_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/ospf6d.vty",ospf6d vty socket) -AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(ISIS_VTYSH_PATH, "$quagga_statedir/isisd.vty",isisd vty socket) AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(DAEMON_VTY_DIR, "$quagga_statedir",daemon vty directory) dnl ------------------------------- diff --git a/doc/.gitignore b/doc/.gitignore index ed527fcb..5071f987 100644 --- a/doc/.gitignore +++ b/doc/.gitignore @@ -6,6 +6,7 @@ quagga.info-* zebra.html defines.texi version.texi +texinfo.tex quagga.html quagga.info *.pdf diff --git a/doc/texinfo.tex b/doc/texinfo.tex deleted file mode 100644 index 58bea4dd..00000000 --- a/doc/texinfo.tex +++ /dev/null @@ -1,7086 +0,0 @@ -% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. -% -% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. -\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi -% -\def\texinfoversion{2005-01-30.17} -% -% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, -% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software -% Foundation, Inc. -% -% This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or -% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as -% published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at -% your option) any later version. -% -% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be -% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty -% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU -% General Public License for more details. -% -% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License -% along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write -% to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, -% Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. -% -% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing -% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without -% restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.) -% -% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug -% reports; you can get the latest version from: -% http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or -% ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex -% (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org). -% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out -% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. -% -% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a -% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the -% problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. -% -% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the -% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple -% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: -% tex foo.texi -% texindex foo.?? -% tex foo.texi -% tex foo.texi -% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. -% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. -% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more -% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. -% -% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some -% extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the -% full Texinfo distribution. -% -% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. - - -\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} - -% If in a .fmt file, print the version number -% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because -% they might have appeared in the input file name. -\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% - \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} - -\message{Basics,} -\chardef\other=12 - -% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. -% For @tex, we can use \tabalign. -\let\+ = \relax - -% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. -\let\ptexb=\b -\let\ptexbullet=\bullet -\let\ptexc=\c -\let\ptexcomma=\, -\let\ptexdot=\. -\let\ptexdots=\dots -\let\ptexend=\end -\let\ptexequiv=\equiv -\let\ptexexclam=\! -\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote -\let\ptexgtr=> -\let\ptexhat=^ -\let\ptexi=\i -\let\ptexindent=\indent -\let\ptexinsert=\insert -\let\ptexlbrace=\{ -\let\ptexless=< -\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite -\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent -\let\ptexplus=+ -\let\ptexrbrace=\} -\let\ptexslash=\/ -\let\ptexstar=\* -\let\ptext=\t - -% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it -% starts a new line in the output. -\newlinechar = `^^J - -% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error -% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. -% -\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined - \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. -\else - \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space} -\fi - -% Set up fixed words for English if not already set. -\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi -\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi -\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi -\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi -\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi -\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi -\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi -\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi -\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi -\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi -\ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi -\ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi -\ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi -\ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi -\ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi -\ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi -\ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi -\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi -\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi -% -\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi -\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi -\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi -\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi -\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi -\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi -\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi -\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi -\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi -\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi -\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi -\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi -% -\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi -\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi -\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi -\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi -\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi - -% In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is -% in some cases the escape char. -\chardef\colonChar = `\: -\chardef\commaChar = `\, -\chardef\dotChar = `\. -\chardef\exclamChar= `\! -\chardef\questChar = `\? -\chardef\semiChar = `\; -\chardef\underChar = `\_ - -\chardef\spaceChar = `\ % -\chardef\spacecat = 10 -\def\spaceisspace{\catcode\spaceChar=\spacecat} - -% Ignore a token. -% -\def\gobble#1{} - -% The following is used inside several \edef's. -\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} - -% Hyphenation fixes. -\hyphenation{ - Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script - ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps - data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script - man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm - par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces - spell-ing spell-ings - stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space - wide-spread wrap-around -} - -% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. -\newdimen\bindingoffset -\newdimen\normaloffset -\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight - -% For a final copy, take out the rectangles -% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided -% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). -% -\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt} - -% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should -% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the -% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would -% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main -% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). -% -\def\|{% - % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. - \leavevmode - % - % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. - \vadjust{% - % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current - % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. - \vskip-\baselineskip - % - % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So - % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. - \llap{% - % - % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. - \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt - % - % This is the space between the bar and the text. - \hskip 12pt - }% - }% -} - -% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file -% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, -% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make -% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log -% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. -% -\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% -\def\loggingall{% - \tracingstats2 - \tracingpages1 - \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex - \tracingparagraphs1 - \tracingoutput1 - \tracingmacros2 - \tracingrestores1 - \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen - \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging - \tracingscantokens1 - \tracingifs1 - \tracinggroups1 - \tracingnesting2 - \tracingassigns1 - \fi - \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex - \errorcontextlines16 -}% - -% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing -% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. -% -\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount - \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} -\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount - \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} -\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount - \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} - -% For @cropmarks command. -% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. -% -\newif\ifcropmarks -\let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue -% -% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. -% Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 -% -\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines -\newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc -\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt -\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in - -% Main output routine. -\chardef\PAGE = 255 -\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} - -\newbox\headlinebox -\newbox\footlinebox - -% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents -% does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. -\def\onepageout#1{% - \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi - % - \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset - \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi - % - % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in - % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). - \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}% - \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}% - % - {% - % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to - % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends - % before the \shipout runs. - % - \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. - \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. - \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if - % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. - \shipout\vbox{% - % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. - \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi - % - \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup - \hsize = \outerhsize - \vskip-\topandbottommargin - \vtop to0pt{% - \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% - \nointerlineskip - \line{% - \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% - \hfill - \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% - }% - \vss}% - \vskip\topandbottommargin - \line\bgroup - \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. - \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi - \vbox\bgroup - \fi - % - \unvbox\headlinebox - \pagebody{#1}% - \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt - % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. - % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.) - % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. - \vskip 2\baselineskip - \unvbox\footlinebox - \fi - % - \ifcropmarks - \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup - \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup - \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill - \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick - \vbox to0pt{\vss - \line{% - \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% - \hfill - \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% - }% - \nointerlineskip - \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% - }% - \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause - \fi - }% end of \shipout\vbox - }% end of group with \normalturnoffactive - \advancepageno - \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi -} - -\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen - -\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} -{\catcode`\@ =11 -\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi -% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) -\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present - \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi -\dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1 -\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi -\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} -} - -% Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are -% offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize -% (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) -% -\def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} -\def\nstop{\vbox - {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} -\def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} -\def\nsbot{\vbox - {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} - -% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of -% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a -% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. -% -\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}} -\def\parseargusing#1#2{% - \def\next{#2}% - \begingroup - \obeylines - \spaceisspace - #1% - \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below. -} - -{\obeylines % - \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% - \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. - \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm% - }% -} - -% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. -\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm} -\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm} - -% Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space. -% -% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g., -% @end itemize @c foo -% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed -% by \finishparsearg. -% -\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M} -\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M} -\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{% - \def\temp{#3}% - \ifx\temp\empty - % We cannot use \next here, as it holds the macro to run; - % thus we reuse \temp. - \let\temp\finishparsearg - \else - \let\temp\argcheckspaces - \fi - % Put the space token in: - \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm -} - -% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so -% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation. -% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now, -% just before passing the control to \next. -% (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is -% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger -% that a pair of braces would be stripped. -% -% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token. -% -\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\next\expandafter{#1}} - -% \parseargdef\foo{...} -% is roughly equivalent to -% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo} -% \def\Xfoo#1{...} -% -% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my -% favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03 - -\def\parseargdef#1{% - \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1% -} -\def\doparseargdef#1#2{% - \def#2{\parsearg#1}% - \def#1##1% -} - -% Several utility definitions with active space: -{ - \obeyspaces - \gdef\obeyedspace{ } - - % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword - % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this - % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input - % should produce a line of output anyway. - % - \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie} - - % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces - % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the - % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). - \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space} -} - - -\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} - -% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this: -% -% \envdef\foo{...} -% \def\Efoo{...} -% -% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the -% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also -% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks -% whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be -% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected. -% -% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they -% are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The -% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this -% special case.) - - -% At runtime, environments start with this: -\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}} -% initialize -\let\thisenv\empty - -% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'': -\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} -\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} - -% Check whether we're in the right environment: -\def\checkenv#1{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\thisenv\temp - \else - \badenverr - \fi -} - -% Evironment mismatch, #1 expected: -\def\badenverr{% - \errhelp = \EMsimple - \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp, - not \inenvironment\thisenv}% -} -\def\inenvironment#1{% - \ifx#1\empty - out of any environment% - \else - in environment \expandafter\string#1% - \fi -} - -% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. -% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv -% -\parseargdef\end{% - \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname - \else - % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03 - \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname - \csname E#1\endcsname - \endgroup - \fi -} - -\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} - - -%% Simple single-character @ commands - -% @@ prints an @ -% Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr). -\def\@{{\tt\char64}} - -% This is turned off because it was never documented -% and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures. -%% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and ' -%% but suppressing ligatures. -%\def\`{{`}} -%\def\'{{'}} - -% Used to generate quoted braces. -\def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}} -\def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}} -\let\{=\mylbrace -\let\}=\myrbrace -\begingroup - % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, - % and @{ and @} for the aux file. - \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other - \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 - \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other - !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% - !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% - !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% - !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% -!endgroup - -% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems. -\let\comma = , - -% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent -% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. -\let\, = \c -\let\dotaccent = \. -\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} -\let\tieaccent = \t -\let\ubaraccent = \b -\let\udotaccent = \d - -% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm -% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. -\def\questiondown{?`} -\def\exclamdown{!`} -\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}} -\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}} - -% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. -\def\imacro{i} -\def\jmacro{j} -\def\dotless#1{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi - \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j - \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% - \fi\fi -} - -% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a -% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.) -% -\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 } - -% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in -% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most -% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using -% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and -% \scriptscriptstyle). -% -\def\LaTeX{% - L\kern-.36em - {\setbox0=\hbox{T}% - \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}% - \kern-.15em - \TeX -} - -% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space -% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space -% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and -% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the -% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. -{\catcode`@ = 11 - % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble - % if the definition is written into an index file. - \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M - \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } -} - -% @: forces normal size whitespace following. -\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } - -% @* forces a line break. -\def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} - -% @/ allows a line break. -\let\/=\allowbreak - -% @. is an end-of-sentence period. -\def\.{.\spacefactor=3000 } - -% @! is an end-of-sentence bang. -\def\!{!\spacefactor=3000 } - -% @? is an end-of-sentence query. -\def\?{?\spacefactor=3000 } - -% @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the -% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would -% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. -\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} - -% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing -% it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box -% to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for -% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is -% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, -% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and -% the text is small, which looks bad. -% -% Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can -% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it -% does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an -% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The -% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit -% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). -% -\newbox\groupbox -\def\vfilllimit{0.7} -% -\envdef\group{% - \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else - \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp - \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% - \fi - \startsavinginserts - % - \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup - % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as - % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an - % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after - % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group - % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo - % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. - \comment -} -% -% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts -% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done) -% \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space -% above. But it's pretty close. -\def\Egroup{% - % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group - % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth. - \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar. - \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth - \egroup % End the \vtop. - % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. - \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox - % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). - \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal - % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big - % group, force a page break. - \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 - \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight - \page - \fi - \fi - \box\groupbox - \prevdepth = \dimen1 - \checkinserts -} -% -% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help -% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. -% -\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% -group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% -where each line of input produces a line of output.} - -% @need space-in-mils -% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. - -\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in - -% Old definition--didn't work. -%\parseargdef\need{\par % -%% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally -%% if the depth of the box does not fit. -%{\baselineskip=0pt% -%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak -%\prevdepth=-1000pt -%}} - -\parseargdef\need{% - % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a - % paragraph. - \par - % - % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. - \dimen0 = #1\mil - \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox - \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox - \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 - % - % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the - % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. - % And a page break here is fine. - \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% - % - % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the - % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the - % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider - % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the - % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. - % - % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the - % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in - % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which - % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing - % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an - % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real - % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. - \penalty9999 - % - % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. - \kern -#1\mil - % - % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. - \nobreak - \fi -} - -% @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented). - -\let\br = \par - -% @page forces the start of a new page. -% -\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} - -% @exdent text.... -% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin - -% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. -% That's how much \exdent should take out. -\newskip\exdentamount - -% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. -\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break} - -% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. -\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount - \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} - -% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current -% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion -% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. -% -\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm -\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} -% -\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% - \nobreak - \kern-\strutdepth - \vtop to \strutdepth{% - \baselineskip=\strutdepth - \vss - % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to - % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. - \ifx#1l% - \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% - \else - \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% - \fi - \null - }% -}} -\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} -\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} -% -% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} -% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; -% else use TEXT for both). -% -\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} -\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% - \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt - \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts - \def\righttext{#2}% - \else - \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text - \def\righttext{#1}% - \fi - % - \ifodd\pageno - \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin - \else - \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% - \fi - \temp -} - -% @include file insert text of that file as input. -% -\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz} -\def\includezzz#1{% - \pushthisfilestack - \def\thisfile{#1}% - {% - \makevalueexpandable - \def\temp{\input #1 }% - \expandafter - }\temp - \popthisfilestack -} -\def\filenamecatcodes{% - \catcode`\\=\other - \catcode`~=\other - \catcode`^=\other - \catcode`_=\other - \catcode`|=\other - \catcode`<=\other - \catcode`>=\other - \catcode`+=\other - \catcode`-=\other -} - -\def\pushthisfilestack{% - \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm -} -\def\pushthisfilestackX{% - \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm -} -\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {% - \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}% -} - -\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty} -\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error: - the stack of filenames is empty.}} - -\def\thisfile{} - -% @center line -% outputs that line, centered. -% -\parseargdef\center{% - \ifhmode - \let\next\centerH - \else - \let\next\centerV - \fi - \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% -} -\def\centerH#1{% - {% - \hfil\break - \advance\hsize by -\leftskip - \advance\hsize by -\rightskip - \line{#1}% - \break - }% -} -\def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}} - -% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space - -\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip} - -% @comment ...line which is ignored... -% @c is the same as @comment -% @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment - -\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% -\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% -\commentxxx} -{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} - -\let\c=\comment - -% @paragraphindent NCHARS -% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. -% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. -% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. -% -\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords -\def\noneword{none} -% -\parseargdef\paragraphindent{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\temp\asisword - \else - \ifx\temp\noneword - \defaultparindent = 0pt - \else - \defaultparindent = #1em - \fi - \fi - \parindent = \defaultparindent -} - -% @exampleindent NCHARS -% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. -% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but -% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. -\parseargdef\exampleindent{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\temp\asisword - \else - \ifx\temp\noneword - \lispnarrowing = 0pt - \else - \lispnarrowing = #1em - \fi - \fi -} - -% @firstparagraphindent WORD -% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph -% after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such -% paragraphs. -% -% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling -% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. -% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. -% By default, we suppress indentation. -% -\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} -\def\insertword{insert} -% -\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\temp\noneword - \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent - \else\ifx\temp\insertword - \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax - \else - \errhelp = \EMsimple - \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% - \fi\fi -} - -% Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to -% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. -% -% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next -% paragraph. -% -\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% - \gdef\indent{% - \restorefirstparagraphindent - \indent - }% - \gdef\noindent{% - \restorefirstparagraphindent - \noindent - }% - \global\everypar = {% - \kern -\parindent - \restorefirstparagraphindent - }% -} - -\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% - \global \let \indent = \ptexindent - \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent - \global \everypar = {}% -} - - -% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. -% -\def\asis#1{#1} - -% @math outputs its argument in math mode. -% -% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean -% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make -% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam, -% which is what @var uses. -{ - \catcode\underChar = \active - \gdef\mathunderscore{% - \catcode\underChar=\active - \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% - } -} -% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character. -% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but -% this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not -% otherwise define @\. -% -% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. -\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} -% -\def\math{% - \tex - \mathunderscore - \let\\ = \mathbackslash - \mathactive - $\finishmath -} -\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex. - -% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. -% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument -% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section). -% -{ - \catcode`^ = \active - \catcode`< = \active - \catcode`> = \active - \catcode`+ = \active - \gdef\mathactive{% - \let^ = \ptexhat - \let< = \ptexless - \let> = \ptexgtr - \let+ = \ptexplus - } -} - -% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above. -\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$} -\def\minus{$-$} - -% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font. -% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter -% font as three actual period characters. -% -\def\dots{% - \leavevmode - \hbox to 1.5em{% - \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil - .\hfil.\hfil.% - \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil - }% -} - -% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. -% -\def\enddots{% - \dots - \spacefactor=3000 -} - -% @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up -% Texinfo's parsing. -% -\let\comma = , - -% @refill is a no-op. -\let\refill=\relax - -% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to -% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. -% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). -% -\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. -\let\novalidate = \linksfalse - -% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. -% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. -% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. -\def\setfilename{% - \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. - \iflinks - \tryauxfile - % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. - \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux - \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. - \openindices - \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. - % - % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. - % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. - \openin 1 texinfo.cnf - \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi - \closein 1 - % - \comment % Ignore the actual filename. -} - -% Called from \setfilename. -% -\def\openindices{% - \newindex{cp}% - \newcodeindex{fn}% - \newcodeindex{vr}% - \newcodeindex{tp}% - \newcodeindex{ky}% - \newcodeindex{pg}% -} - -% @bye. -\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} - - -\message{pdf,} -% adobe `portable' document format -\newcount\tempnum -\newcount\lnkcount -\newtoks\filename -\newcount\filenamelength -\newcount\pgn -\newtoks\toksA -\newtoks\toksB -\newtoks\toksC -\newtoks\toksD -\newbox\boxA -\newcount\countA -\newif\ifpdf -\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest - -% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1 -% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined, -% borrowed from ifpdf.sty. -\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined -\else - \ifx\pdfoutput\relax - \else - \ifcase\pdfoutput - \else - \pdftrue - \fi - \fi -\fi -% -\ifpdf - \input pdfcolor - \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}% - \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% - \def\imagewidth{#2}% - \def\imageheight{#3}% - % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is - % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) - \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 - \immediate\pdfimage - \else - \immediate\pdfximage - \fi - \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi - \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi - \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 - #1.pdf% - \else - {#1.pdf}% - \fi - \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else - \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage - \fi} - \def\pdfmkdest#1{{% - % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code in a section title - % aren't expanded. - \atdummies - \normalturnoffactive - \pdfdest name{#1} xyz% - }} - \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} - \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light? - \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink} - % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines - % come from Petr Olsak - \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% - \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} - \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax - \advance\tempnum by 1 - \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} - % - % #1 is the section text. #2 is the pdf expression for the number - % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node - % text, which might be empty if this toc entry had no - % corresponding node. #4 is the page number. - % - \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% - % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the - % page number. We could generate a destination for the section - % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't - % seem worthwhile, since most documents are normally structured. - \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% - \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}\fi - % - \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{#1}% - } - % - \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% - \begingroup - % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks - \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace - \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace - % - % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. - \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% - \def\thischapnum{##2}% - \def\thissecnum{0}% - \def\thissubsecnum{0}% - }% - \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% - \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}% - \def\thissecnum{##2}% - \def\thissubsecnum{0}% - }% - \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% - \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}% - \def\thissubsecnum{##2}% - }% - \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% - \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}% - }% - \def\thischapnum{0}% - \def\thissecnum{0}% - \def\thissubsecnum{0}% - % - % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et - % al. a second time, below. - \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% - \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% - \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% - \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% - \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% - \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% - \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% - \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% - \input \jobname.toc - % - % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. - % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of - % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. - % - % We use the node names as the destinations. - \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% - \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% - \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% - \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% - \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% - \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% - \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero - \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% - % - % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of - % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters, - % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from - % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from - % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100. - % - % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to - % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right - % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way. - \indexnofonts - \turnoffactive - \input \jobname.toc - \endgroup - } - % - \def\makelinks #1,{% - \def\params{#1}\def\E{END}% - \ifx\params\E - \let\nextmakelinks=\relax - \else - \let\nextmakelinks=\makelinks - \ifnum\lnkcount>0,\fi - \picknum{#1}% - \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} - goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\the\pgn}}% - \linkcolor #1% - \advance\lnkcount by 1% - \endlink - \fi - \nextmakelinks - } - \def\picknum#1{\expandafter\pn#1} - \def\pn#1{% - \def\p{#1}% - \ifx\p\lbrace - \let\nextpn=\ppn - \else - \let\nextpn=\ppnn - \def\first{#1} - \fi - \nextpn - } - \def\ppn#1{\pgn=#1\gobble} - \def\ppnn{\pgn=\first} - \def\pdfmklnk#1{\lnkcount=0\makelinks #1,END,} - \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% - \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax - \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces - \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% - \advance\filenamelength by 1 - \fi - \fi - \nextsp} - \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax} - \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 - \let \startlink \pdfannotlink - \else - \let \startlink \pdfstartlink - \fi - \def\pdfurl#1{% - \begingroup - \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}% - \makevalueexpandable - \leavevmode\Red - \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% - user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% - \endgroup} - \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} - \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} - \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} - \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} - \def\maketoks{% - \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax - \ifx\first0\adn0 - \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 - \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 - \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 - \else - \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi - \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else - \let\next=\maketoks - \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} - \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi - \fi - \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi - \next} - \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% - {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} - \def\pdflink#1{% - \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} - \linkcolor #1\endlink} - \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} -\else - \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble - \let\pdfurl = \gobble - \let\endlink = \relax - \let\linkcolor = \relax - \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax -\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput - - -\message{fonts,} - -% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle. -% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in -% italics, not bold italics. -% -\def\setfontstyle#1{% - \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd. - \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font -} - -% Select #1 fonts with the current style. -% -\def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname} - -\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}} -\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}} -\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}} -\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf} -\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}} - -% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. -% So we set up a \sf. -\newfam\sffam -\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}} -\let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. - -% We don't need math for this font style. -\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}} - -% Default leading. -\newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt - -% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size -% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers -% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. -% -\def\lineskipfactor{.08333} -\def\strutheightpercent{.70833} -\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} -% -\def\setleading#1{% - \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax - \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip - \normalbaselines - \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% - \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip - depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip - }% -} - -% Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the -% specified font prefix (normally `cm'). -% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor -\def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4} - -% Use cm as the default font prefix. -% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix -% before you read in texinfo.tex. -\ifx\fontprefix\undefined -\def\fontprefix{cm} -\fi -% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. -\def\rmshape{r} -\def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold -\def\bfshape{b} -\def\bxshape{bx} -\def\ttshape{tt} -\def\ttbshape{tt} -\def\ttslshape{sltt} -\def\itshape{ti} -\def\itbshape{bxti} -\def\slshape{sl} -\def\slbshape{bxsl} -\def\sfshape{ss} -\def\sfbshape{ss} -\def\scshape{csc} -\def\scbshape{csc} - -% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1). -\def\textnominalsize{11pt} -\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf} -\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep} -\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep -\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep - -% A few fonts for @defun names and args. -\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} -\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1} -\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1} -\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} - -% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). -\def\smallnominalsize{9pt} -\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900} -\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000} -\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900} -\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900} -\font\smalli=cmmi9 -\font\smallsy=cmsy9 - -% Fonts for small examples (8pt). -\def\smallernominalsize{8pt} -\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000} -\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000} -\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800} -\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000} -\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000} -\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000} -\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800} -\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800} -\font\smalleri=cmmi8 -\font\smallersy=cmsy8 - -% Fonts for title page (20.4pt): -\def\titlenominalsize{20pt} -\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3} -\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4} -\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4} -\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3} -\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4} -\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1} -\let\titlebf=\titlerm -\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4} -\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 -\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 -\def\authorrm{\secrm} -\def\authortt{\sectt} - -% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). -\def\chapnominalsize{17pt} -\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2} -\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3} -\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3} -\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2} -\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3} -\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000} -\let\chapbf=\chaprm -\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3} -\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 -\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 - -% Section fonts (14.4pt). -\def\secnominalsize{14pt} -\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1} -\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2} -\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2} -\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1} -\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2} -\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1} -\let\secbf\secrm -\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2} -\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 -\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 - -% Subsection fonts (13.15pt). -\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt} -\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315} -\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315} -\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf} -\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315} -\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf} -\let\ssecbf\ssecrm -\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315} -\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf -\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 - -% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt). -\def\reducednominalsize{10pt} -\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000} -\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000} -\font\reducedi=cmmi10 -\font\reducedsy=cmsy10 - -% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, -% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since -% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except -% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and -% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts). -% -\def\resetmathfonts{% - \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy - \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf - \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf -} - -% The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead -% of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the -% current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire -% \tenSTYLE to set the current font. -% -% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower) -% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in -% the LaTeX logo and acronyms. -% -% This all needs generalizing, badly. -% -\def\textfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl - \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc - \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy - \let\tenttsl=\textttsl - \def\curfontsize{text}% - \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} -\def\titlefonts{% - \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl - \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc - \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy - \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl - \def\curfontsize{title}% - \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}} -\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}} -\def\chapfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl - \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc - \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy - \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl - \def\curfontsize{chap}% - \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} -\def\secfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl - \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc - \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy - \let\tenttsl=\secttsl - \def\curfontsize{sec}% - \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}} -\def\subsecfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl - \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc - \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy - \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl - \def\curfontsize{ssec}% - \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} -\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts -\def\reducedfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl - \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc - \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy - \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl - \def\curfontsize{reduced}% - \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} -\def\smallfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl - \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc - \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy - \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl - \def\curfontsize{small}% - \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} -\def\smallerfonts{% - \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl - \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc - \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy - \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl - \def\curfontsize{smaller}% - \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% - \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} - -% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. -\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts - -% About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample -% can fit this many characters: -% 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 -% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: -% 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 -% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth -% the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. -% -% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): -% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 -% -% I wish the USA used A4 paper. -% --karl, 24jan03. - - -% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. -% -\textfonts \rm - -% Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts. -\def\angleleft{$\langle$} -\def\angleright{$\rangle$} - -% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks -\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 - -% Fonts for short table of contents. -\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000} -\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12 -\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000} -\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000} - -%% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans -%% serif) and @ii for TeX italic - -% \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction -% unless the following character is such as not to need one. -\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else - \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi} -\def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} -\def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} - -% like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl. -% @var is set to this for defun arguments. -\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} - -% like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want -% ttsl for book titles, do we? -\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx} - -\let\i=\smartitalic -\let\slanted=\smartslanted -\let\var=\smartslanted -\let\dfn=\smartslanted -\let\emph=\smartitalic - -% @b, explicit bold. -\def\b#1{{\bf #1}} -\let\strong=\b - -% @sansserif, explicit sans. -\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}} - -% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at -% the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the -% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. -% -\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} -\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } - -% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. -% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and -% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. -% -\catcode`@=11 - \def\frenchspacing{% - \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m - \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m - } -\catcode`@=\other - -\def\t#1{% - {\tt \rawbackslash \frenchspacing #1}% - \null -} -\def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null} -\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000} -\font\keysy=cmsy9 -\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% - \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% - \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt - \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% - \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% - \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} -% The old definition, with no lozenge: -%\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null} -\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} - -% @file, @option are the same as @samp. -\let\file=\samp -\let\option=\samp - -% @code is a modification of @t, -% which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text. -\def\tclose#1{% - {% - % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. - \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font - % - % Switch to typewriter. - \tt - % - % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. - \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% - % - % Turn off hyphenation. - \nohyphenation - % - \rawbackslash - \frenchspacing - #1% - }% - \null -} - -% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code. -% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes -% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. - -% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control -% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. -% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) -% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -% -- rms. -{ - \catcode`\-=\active - \catcode`\_=\active - % - \global\def\code{\begingroup - \catcode`\-=\active \let-\codedash - \catcode`\_=\active \let_\codeunder - \codex - } -} - -\def\realdash{-} -\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}} -\def\codeunder{% - % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ - % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) - % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us - % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. - \ifusingtt{\ifmmode - \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. - \else\normalunderscore \fi - \discretionary{}{}{}}% - {\_}% -} -\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} - -% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, -% then @kbd has no effect. - -% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), -% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), -% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). -\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{% - \def\arg{#1}% - \ifx\arg\worddistinct - \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% - \else\ifx\arg\wordexample - \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% - \else\ifx\arg\wordcode - \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% - \else - \errhelp = \EMsimple - \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\arg'}% - \fi\fi\fi -} -\def\worddistinct{distinct} -\def\wordexample{example} -\def\wordcode{code} - -% Default is `distinct.' -\kbdinputstyle distinct - -\def\xkey{\key} -\def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% -\ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% -\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi -\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi} - -% For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code. -\let\indicateurl=\code -\let\env=\code -\let\command=\code - -% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated) -% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third -% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url -% itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in -% a hypertex \special here. -% -\def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish} -\def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup - \unsepspaces - \pdfurl{#1}% - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% - \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt - \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that - \else - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% - \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt - \ifpdf - \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it - \else - \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url - \fi - \else - \code{#1}% only url given, so show it - \fi - \fi - \endlink -\endgroup} - -% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it. -% -\let\url=\uref - -% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. -% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. -% -%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} -\ifpdf - \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} - \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup - \unsepspaces - \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% - \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi - \endlink - \endgroup} -\else - \let\email=\uref -\fi - -% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the -% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and -% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have -% this property, we can check that font parameter. -% -\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } - -% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the -% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. -% -\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} - -\def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par} - -% @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', -% and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for -% Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. -%\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} - -% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. -\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font -\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font -\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font - -% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like. -% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for -% all-uppercase. -% -\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish} -\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{% - {\selectfonts\lsize #1}% - \def\temp{#2}% - \ifx\temp\empty \else - \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% - \fi -} - -% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like. -% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing. -% -\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish} -\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{% - {\frenchspacing #1}% - \def\temp{#2}% - \ifx\temp\empty \else - \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% - \fi -} - -% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font. -% -\def\pounds{{\it\$}} - -% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style. -% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik -% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and -% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need). -% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym. -% -% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore -% that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular -% font height. -% -% feymr - regular -% feymo - slanted -% feybr - bold -% feybo - bold slanted -% -% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge. -% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide. -% Hmm. -% -% Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols? -% Hope not. -% -% -\def\euro{{\eurofont e}} -\def\eurofont{% - % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in - % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that - % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the - % font installed. - % - % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale - % that to the current nominal size. - % - % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but - % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts. - % - \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% - % - \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename - % bold: - \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize - \else - % regular: - \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize - \fi - \thiseurofont -} - -% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really -% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now. -% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. -% -\def\registeredsymbol{% - $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}% - \hfil\crcr\Orb}}% - }$% -} - -% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with: -% Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38 -% so we'll define it if necessary. -% -\ifx\Orb\undefined -\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D} -\fi - - -\message{page headings,} - -\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in -\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc - -% First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. -\newif\ifseenauthor -\newif\iffinishedtitlepage - -% Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the -% user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. -% -\newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage - \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue -\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage - \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue - -\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% - \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} - -\envdef\titlepage{% - % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage. - \begingroup - \parindent=0pt \textfonts - % Leave some space at the very top of the page. - \vglue\titlepagetopglue - % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. - \finishedtitlepagetrue - % - % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space - % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. - \let\oldpage = \page - \def\page{% - \iffinishedtitlepage\else - \finishtitlepage - \fi - \let\page = \oldpage - \page - \null - }% -} - -\def\Etitlepage{% - \iffinishedtitlepage\else - \finishtitlepage - \fi - % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, - % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. - % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page - % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. - \oldpage - \endgroup - % - % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are - % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. - \HEADINGSon - % - % If they want short, they certainly want long too. - \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage - \shortcontents - \contents - \global\let\shortcontents = \relax - \global\let\contents = \relax - \fi - % - \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage - \contents - \global\let\contents = \relax - \global\let\shortcontents = \relax - \fi -} - -\def\finishtitlepage{% - \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize - \vskip\titlepagebottomglue - \finishedtitlepagetrue -} - -%%% Macros to be used within @titlepage: - -\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm -\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines} - -\def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines - \let\tt=\authortt} - -\parseargdef\title{% - \checkenv\titlepage - \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1} - % print a rule at the page bottom also. - \finishedtitlepagefalse - \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt -} - -\parseargdef\subtitle{% - \checkenv\titlepage - {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}% -} - -% @author should come last, but may come many times. -% It can also be used inside @quotation. -% -\parseargdef\author{% - \def\temp{\quotation}% - \ifx\thisenv\temp - \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation. - \else - \checkenv\titlepage - \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi - {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}% - \fi -} - - -%%% Set up page headings and footings. - -\let\thispage=\folio - -\newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages -\newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages -\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages -\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages - -% Now make TeX use those variables -\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline - \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} -\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline - \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} -\let\HEADINGShook=\relax - -% Commands to set those variables. -% For example, this is what @headings on does -% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter -% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle -% @evenfooting @thisfile|| -% @oddfooting ||@thisfile - - -\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} -\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} -\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% -\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} - -\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} -\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} -\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% -\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} - -\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% - -\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} -\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} -\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% -\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} - -\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} -\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} -\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% - \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% - % - % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume - % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. - \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip - \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip -} - -\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} - - -% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. -% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. -% @headings off turns them off. -% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. -% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. -% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. -% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. -% By default, they are off at the start of a document, -% and turned `on' after @end titlepage. - -\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} - -\def\HEADINGSoff{% -\global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil} -\global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}} -\HEADINGSoff -% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. -% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, -% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document -% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top -% edge of all pages. -\def\HEADINGSdouble{% -\global\pageno=1 -\global\evenfootline={\hfil} -\global\oddfootline={\hfil} -\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} -\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage -} -\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager - -% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, -% page number on top right. -\def\HEADINGSsingle{% -\global\pageno=1 -\global\evenfootline={\hfil} -\global\oddfootline={\hfil} -\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} -\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager -} -\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} - -\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} -\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter -\def\HEADINGSdoublex{% -\global\evenfootline={\hfil} -\global\oddfootline={\hfil} -\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} -\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage -} - -\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} -\def\HEADINGSsinglex{% -\global\evenfootline={\hfil} -\global\oddfootline={\hfil} -\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} -\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager -} - -% Subroutines used in generating headings -% This produces Day Month Year style of output. -% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set -% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). -\ifx\today\undefined -\def\today{% - \number\day\space - \ifcase\month - \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr - \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug - \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec - \fi - \space\number\year} -\fi - -% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. -% It generates no output of its own. -\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} -\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}} - - -\message{tables,} -% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x). - -% default indentation of table text -\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in -% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text -\newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in -% margin between end of table item and start of table text. -\newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in - -% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin -\newdimen\itemmax - -% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with -% these defs. -% They also define \itemindex -% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). - -\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip - -\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} - -\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} -\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} - -\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % - \advance\hsize by -\rightskip - \advance\hsize by -\tableindent - \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}% - \itemindex{#1}% - \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. - % - % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line - % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that - % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next - % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the - % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. - \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax - % - % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, - % but leave it ragged-right. - \begingroup - \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent - \advance\hsize by\tableindent - \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil - \leavevmode\unhbox0\par - \endgroup - % - % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the - % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. - \nobreak \vskip-\parskip - % - % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if - % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no - % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would - % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this - % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert - % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also. - % - \penalty 10001 - \endgroup - \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse - \else - % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the - % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. - \noindent - % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in - % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and - % eventually be printed. - \nobreak\kern-\tableindent - \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 - \unhbox0 - \nobreak\kern\dimen0 - \endgroup - \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue - \fi -} - -\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}} -\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}} - -% @table, @ftable, @vtable. -\envdef\table{% - \let\itemindex\gobble - \tablecheck{table}% -} -\envdef\ftable{% - \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}% - \tablecheck{ftable}% -} -\envdef\vtable{% - \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}% - \tablecheck{vtable}% -} -\def\tablecheck#1{% - \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active - \endgroup - \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is - that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}% - \def\next{\doignore{#1}}% - \else - \let\next\tablex - \fi - \next -} -\def\tablex#1{% - \def\itemindicate{#1}% - \parsearg\tabley -} -\def\tabley#1{% - {% - \makevalueexpandable - \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}% - \expandafter - }\temp \endtablez -} -\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{% - \aboveenvbreak - \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi - \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi - \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi - \itemmax=\tableindent - \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin - \advance \leftskip by \tableindent - \exdentamount=\tableindent - \parindent = 0pt - \parskip = \smallskipamount - \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi - \let\item = \internalBitem - \let\itemx = \internalBitemx -} -\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak} -\let\Eftable\Etable -\let\Evtable\Etable -\let\Eitemize\Etable -\let\Eenumerate\Etable - -% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize - -\newcount \itemno - -\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize} - -\def\doitemize#1{% - \aboveenvbreak - \itemmax=\itemindent - \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin - \advance\leftskip by \itemindent - \exdentamount=\itemindent - \parindent=0pt - \parskip=\smallskipamount - \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi - \def\itemcontents{#1}% - % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. - \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi - \let\item=\itemizeitem -} - -% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate. -% -\def\itemizeitem{% - \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations - {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break - {% - % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a - % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have - % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero - % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the - % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there - % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much - % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least - % that's the theory. - \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi - \noindent - \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}% - \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item. - \flushcr -} - -% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in -% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. -% -\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% - -% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, -% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No -% argument is the same as `1'. -% -\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} -\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% - % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. - \def\thearg{#1}% - \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi - % - % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a - % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. - % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. - % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at - % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) - \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark - \ifx\rest\empty - % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. - % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. - % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and - % not equal to itself. - % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. - % - % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from - % continuing to look for a <number>. - % - \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax - \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) - \else - % It's a letter. - \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax - \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter - \else - \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter - \fi - \fi - \else - % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. - \numericenumerate - \fi -} - -% An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is -% given in \thearg. -% -\def\numericenumerate{% - \itemno = \thearg - \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% -} - -% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. -\def\lowercaseenumerate{% - \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg - \startenumeration{% - % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. - \ifnum\itemno=0 - \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger - alphabet}% - \fi - \char\lccode\itemno - }% -} - -% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. -\def\uppercaseenumerate{% - \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg - \startenumeration{% - % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. - \ifnum\itemno=0 - \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger - alphabet} - \fi - \char\uccode\itemno - }% -} - -% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the -% common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in -% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. -% -\def\startenumeration#1{% - \advance\itemno by -1 - \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr -} - -% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg -% to @enumerate. -% -\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} -\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} -\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} -\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} - - -% @multitable macros -% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 -% -% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. -% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width -% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, -% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. - -% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. - -% To make preamble: -% -% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: -% @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 -% @item ... -% -% Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total -% current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many -% columns as desired. - - -% Or use a template: -% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} -% @item ... -% using the widest term desired in each column. - -% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column -% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's -% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, -% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. - -% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt -% if they are. - -% Sample multitable: - -% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} -% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col -% @item -% first col stuff -% @tab -% second col stuff -% @tab -% third col -% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff -% @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. -% -% They will wrap at the width determined by the template. -% @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. -% @end multitable - -% Default dimensions may be reset by user. -% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. -% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. -% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. -% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline -% to baseline. -% 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. -% -\newskip\multitableparskip -\newskip\multitableparindent -\newdimen\multitablecolspace -\newskip\multitablelinespace -\multitableparskip=0pt -\multitableparindent=6pt -\multitablecolspace=12pt -\multitablelinespace=0pt - -% Macros used to set up halign preamble: -% -\let\endsetuptable\relax -\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} -\let\columnfractions\relax -\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} -\newif\ifsetpercent - -% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might -% be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is. -% -\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {% - \global\advance\colcount by 1 - \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}% - \setuptable -} - -\newcount\colcount -\def\setuptable#1{% - \def\firstarg{#1}% - \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable - \let\go = \relax - \else - \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions - \global\setpercenttrue - \else - \ifsetpercent - \let\go\pickupwholefraction - \else - \global\advance\colcount by 1 - \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a - % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. - \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% - \fi - \fi - \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction - % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so - % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. - \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% - \else - \let\go = \setuptable - \fi% - \fi - \go -} - -% multitable-only commands. -% -% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. -% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group -% of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab. -\def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}% -% -% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template -% line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until -% we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again. -% --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. -\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}% - -% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: -% -\newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab. -% -\envdef\multitable{% - \vskip\parskip - \startsavinginserts - % - % @item within a multitable starts a normal row. - % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries - % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka - % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize. - \def\item{\crcr}% - % - \tolerance=9500 - \hbadness=9500 - \setmultitablespacing - \parskip=\multitableparskip - \parindent=\multitableparindent - \overfullrule=0pt - \global\colcount=0 - % - \everycr = {% - \noalign{% - \global\everytab={}% - \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter. - % Check for saved footnotes, etc. - \checkinserts - % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages. - %\filbreak - % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the - % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the - % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl. - }% - }% - % - \parsearg\domultitable -} -\def\domultitable#1{% - % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: - \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable - % - % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will - % be used as many times as user calls for columns. - % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and - % continue for many paragraphs if desired. - \halign\bgroup &% - \global\advance\colcount by 1 - \multistrut - \vtop{% - % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width: - \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname - % - % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other - % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after - % the first one. - % - % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace - % to the width of each template entry. - % - % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will - % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip - % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at - % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. - % - % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. - \rightskip=0pt - \ifnum\colcount=1 - % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. - \advance\hsize by\leftskip - \else - \ifsetpercent \else - % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize - % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. - \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace - \fi - % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: - \leftskip=\multitablecolspace - \fi - % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious - % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the - % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. - % For example: - % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 - % @item @code{#} - % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. - % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively - % marking characters. - \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut - }\cr -} -\def\Emultitable{% - \crcr - \egroup % end the \halign - \global\setpercentfalse -} - -\def\setmultitablespacing{% - \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing - % - % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in - % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on - % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off. - % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100. -\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt -\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip -\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 -\fi -%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of -%% table. If not, do nothing. -%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. -\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace -\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace -\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller - %% than skip between lines in the table. -\fi% -\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt -\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace -\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller - %% than skip between lines in the table. -\fi} - - -\message{conditionals,} - -% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext, -% @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't -% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we -% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't -% attempt to close an environment group. -% -\def\makecond#1{% - \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax - \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1 -} -\makecond{iftex} -\makecond{ifnotdocbook} -\makecond{ifnothtml} -\makecond{ifnotinfo} -\makecond{ifnotplaintext} -\makecond{ifnotxml} - -% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. -% -\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} -\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} -\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}} -\def\html{\doignore{html}} -\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}} -\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} -\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} -\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} -\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} -\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} -\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} -\def\menu{\doignore{menu}} -\def\xml{\doignore{xml}} - -% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. -% -% A count to remember the depth of nesting. -\newcount\doignorecount - -\def\doignore#1{\begingroup - % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode: - \catcode`\@ = \other - \catcode`\{ = \other - \catcode`\} = \other - % - % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. - \spaceisspace - % - % Count number of #1's that we've seen. - \doignorecount = 0 - % - % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. - \dodoignore{#1}% -} - -{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source. - \obeylines % - % - \gdef\dodoignore#1{% - % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'. - % - % Define a command to find the next `@end #1', which must be on a line - % by itself. - \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}% - % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a - % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for - % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) - \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}% - % - % And now expand that command. - \obeylines % - \doignoretext ^^M% - }% -} - -\def\doignoreyyy#1{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. - \let\next\doignoretextzzz - \else % Found a nested condition, ... - \advance\doignorecount by 1 - \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. - % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). - \fi - \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro. -} - -% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_". -% -\def\doignoretextzzz#1{% - \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. - \let\next\enddoignore - \else % Still inside a nested condition. - \advance\doignorecount by -1 - \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. - \fi - \next -} - -% Finish off ignored text. -\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces} - - -% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. -% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. -% -% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be -% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our -% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we -% didn't need it. -% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10. -% -\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} -\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% - {% - \makevalueexpandable - \def\temp{#2}% - \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}% - \ifx\temp\empty - \next{}% - \else - \setzzz#2\endsetzzz - \fi - }% -} -% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. -\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}} - -% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. -% -\parseargdef\clear{% - {% - \makevalueexpandable - \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax - }% -} - -% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. -\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx} -\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} -{ - \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active - % - \gdef\makevalueexpandable{% - \let\value = \expandablevalue - % We don't want these characters active, ... - \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other - % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if - % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though. - % So \let them to their normal equivalents. - \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore - } -} - -% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's -% properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies). -% The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since -% the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the -% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain -% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work -% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). -% -\def\expandablevalue#1{% - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax - {[No value for ``#1'']}% - \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% - \else - \csname SET#1\endcsname - \fi -} - -% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined -% with @set. -% -% To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine. -% -\makecond{ifset} -\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}} -\def\doifset#1#2{% - {% - \makevalueexpandable - \let\next=\empty - \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax - #1% If not set, redefine \next. - \fi - \expandafter - }\next -} -\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} - -% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been -% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. -% -% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the -% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set, -% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail. -% -\makecond{ifclear} -\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}} -\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} - -% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file -% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. -\let\dircategory=\comment - -% @defininfoenclose. -\let\definfoenclose=\comment - - -\message{indexing,} -% Index generation facilities - -% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite -% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's. -\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}} - -% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. -% It automatically defines \fooindex such that -% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. -% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for -% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. -% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long -% for the sake of vms. -% -\def\newindex#1{% - \iflinks - \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname - \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file - \fi - \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index - \noexpand\doindex{#1}} -} - -% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} -% -\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} - -% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. -% -\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} -% -\def\newcodeindex#1{% - \iflinks - \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname - \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 - \fi - \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% - \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% -} - - -% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. -% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. -% -% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo -% inside @code. -% -\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} -\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} - -% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), -% #3 the target index (bar). -\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% - % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up - % closing the target index. - \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined - % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the - % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. - \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname - \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 - \fi - % redefine \fooindfile: - \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname - \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp - % redefine \fooindex: - \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% -} - -% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. -% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, -% and it is "foo", the name of the index. - -% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. -% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. - -% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} -% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. - -\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} -\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} - -% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. -\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} -\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} - -% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. -% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, -% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. -% -\def\indexdummies{% - \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. - \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% - % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. - % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes - % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. - \let\{ = \mylbrace - \let\} = \myrbrace - % - % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \realbackslash #1\space, thus - % effectively preventing its expansion. This is used only for control - % words, not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect - % for control characters, but is needed to separate the control word - % from whatever follows. - % - % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the - % space. - % - % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and - % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then - % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). - % - \def\definedummyword##1{% - \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1\space}% - }% - \def\definedummyletter##1{% - \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{\realbackslash ##1}% - }% - \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter - % - % Do the redefinitions. - \commondummies -} - -% For the aux file, @ is the escape character. So we want to redefine -% everything using @ instead of \realbackslash. When everything uses -% @, this will be simpler. -% -\def\atdummies{% - \def\@{@@}% - \def\ {@ }% - \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd - \let\} = \rbraceatcmd - % - % (See comments in \indexdummies.) - \def\definedummyword##1{% - \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1\space}% - }% - \def\definedummyletter##1{% - \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{@##1}% - }% - \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter - % - % Do the redefinitions. - \commondummies -} - -% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. \definedummyword and -% \definedummyletter must be defined first. -% -\def\commondummies{% - % - \normalturnoffactive - % - \commondummiesnofonts - % - \definedummyletter{_}% - % - % Non-English letters. - \definedummyword{AA}% - \definedummyword{AE}% - \definedummyword{L}% - \definedummyword{OE}% - \definedummyword{O}% - \definedummyword{aa}% - \definedummyword{ae}% - \definedummyword{l}% - \definedummyword{oe}% - \definedummyword{o}% - \definedummyword{ss}% - \definedummyword{exclamdown}% - \definedummyword{questiondown}% - \definedummyword{ordf}% - \definedummyword{ordm}% - % - % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. - \definedummyword{bf}% - \definedummyword{gtr}% - \definedummyword{hat}% - \definedummyword{less}% - \definedummyword{sf}% - \definedummyword{sl}% - \definedummyword{tclose}% - \definedummyword{tt}% - % - \definedummyword{LaTeX}% - \definedummyword{TeX}% - % - % Assorted special characters. - \definedummyword{bullet}% - \definedummyword{comma}% - \definedummyword{copyright}% - \definedummyword{registeredsymbol}% - \definedummyword{dots}% - \definedummyword{enddots}% - \definedummyword{equiv}% - \definedummyword{error}% - \definedummyword{euro}% - \definedummyword{expansion}% - \definedummyword{minus}% - \definedummyword{pounds}% - \definedummyword{point}% - \definedummyword{print}% - \definedummyword{result}% - % - % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any - % (non-fully-expandable) commands. - \makevalueexpandable - % - % Normal spaces, not active ones. - \unsepspaces - % - % No macro expansion. - \turnoffmacros -} - -% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts. -% -% Better have this without active chars. -{ - \catcode`\~=\other - \gdef\commondummiesnofonts{% - % Control letters and accents. - \definedummyletter{!}% - \definedummyaccent{"}% - \definedummyaccent{'}% - \definedummyletter{*}% - \definedummyaccent{,}% - \definedummyletter{.}% - \definedummyletter{/}% - \definedummyletter{:}% - \definedummyaccent{=}% - \definedummyletter{?}% - \definedummyaccent{^}% - \definedummyaccent{`}% - \definedummyaccent{~}% - \definedummyword{u}% - \definedummyword{v}% - \definedummyword{H}% - \definedummyword{dotaccent}% - \definedummyword{ringaccent}% - \definedummyword{tieaccent}% - \definedummyword{ubaraccent}% - \definedummyword{udotaccent}% - \definedummyword{dotless}% - % - % Texinfo font commands. - \definedummyword{b}% - \definedummyword{i}% - \definedummyword{r}% - \definedummyword{sc}% - \definedummyword{t}% - % - % Commands that take arguments. - \definedummyword{acronym}% - \definedummyword{cite}% - \definedummyword{code}% - \definedummyword{command}% - \definedummyword{dfn}% - \definedummyword{emph}% - \definedummyword{env}% - \definedummyword{file}% - \definedummyword{kbd}% - \definedummyword{key}% - \definedummyword{math}% - \definedummyword{option}% - \definedummyword{samp}% - \definedummyword{strong}% - \definedummyword{tie}% - \definedummyword{uref}% - \definedummyword{url}% - \definedummyword{var}% - \definedummyword{verb}% - \definedummyword{w}% - } -} - -% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index -% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all -% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string -% would be for a given command (usually its argument). -% -\def\indexnofonts{% - % Accent commands should become @asis. - \def\definedummyaccent##1{% - \expandafter\let\csname ##1\endcsname\asis - }% - % We can just ignore other control letters. - \def\definedummyletter##1{% - \expandafter\def\csname ##1\endcsname{}% - }% - % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis. - \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent - % - \commondummiesnofonts - % - % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command - % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. - % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. - %\let\tt=\asis - % - \def\ { }% - \def\@{@}% - % how to handle braces? - \def\_{\normalunderscore}% - % - % Non-English letters. - \def\AA{AA}% - \def\AE{AE}% - \def\L{L}% - \def\OE{OE}% - \def\O{O}% - \def\aa{aa}% - \def\ae{ae}% - \def\l{l}% - \def\oe{oe}% - \def\o{o}% - \def\ss{ss}% - \def\exclamdown{!}% - \def\questiondown{?}% - \def\ordf{a}% - \def\ordm{o}% - % - \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}% - \def\TeX{TeX}% - % - % Assorted special characters. - % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.) - \def\bullet{bullet}% - \def\comma{,}% - \def\copyright{copyright}% - \def\registeredsymbol{R}% - \def\dots{...}% - \def\enddots{...}% - \def\equiv{==}% - \def\error{error}% - \def\euro{euro}% - \def\expansion{==>}% - \def\minus{-}% - \def\pounds{pounds}% - \def\point{.}% - \def\print{-|}% - \def\result{=>}% - % - % Don't write macro names. - \emptyusermacros -} - -\let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. -\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? - -% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. -% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text. -\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} - -% Workhorse for all \fooindexes. -% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- -% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception -% is with most defuns, which call us directly). -% -\def\dosubind#1#2#3{% - \iflinks - {% - % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). - \toks0 = {#2}% - % If third arg is present, precede it with a space. - \def\thirdarg{#3}% - \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else - \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% - \fi - % - \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% - % - \ifvmode - \dosubindsanitize - \else - \dosubindwrite - \fi - }% - \fi -} - -% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file: -% -\def\dosubindwrite{% - % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. - \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else - \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% - \fi - % - % Remember, we are within a group. - \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage - \escapechar=`\\ - \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now - % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. - % - % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to - % get the string to sort by. - {\indexnofonts - \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion - \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% - }% - % - % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and - % the original text, including any font commands. We write - % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the - % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s - % sorted result. - \edef\temp{% - \write\writeto{% - \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% - }% - \temp -} - -% Take care of unwanted page breaks: -% -% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it -% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting -% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the -% \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences -% like this: -% @end defun -% @tindex whatever -% @defun ... -% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the -% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of -% the previous defun. -% -% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We -% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. -% -% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. -% -% But wait, there is a catch there: -% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not -% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts -% of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual -% representation of the skip. -% -% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that -% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter). -% -\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname} -% -% ..., ready, GO: -% -\def\dosubindsanitize{% - % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. - \skip0 = \lastskip - \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}% - \count255 = \lastpenalty - % - % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a - % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this - % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a - % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential - % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. - \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro - \else - \vskip-\skip0 - \fi - % - \dosubindwrite - % - \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro - % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and - % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want - % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various - % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any - % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example: - % - % @deffn deffn-whatever - % @vindex index-whatever - % Description. - % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit - % and the "Description." paragraph. - \ifnum\count255>9999 \penalty\count255 \fi - \else - % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, - % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item - % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. - \nobreak\vskip\skip0 - \fi -} - -% The index entry written in the file actually looks like -% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} -% or -% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} -% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files -% containing these kinds of lines: -% \initial {c} -% before the first topic whose initial is c -% \entry {topic}{pagelist} -% for a topic that is used without subtopics -% \primary {topic} -% for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics -% \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} -% for each subtopic. - -% Define the user-accessible indexing commands -% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. - -\def\findex {\fnindex} -\def\kindex {\kyindex} -\def\cindex {\cpindex} -\def\vindex {\vrindex} -\def\tindex {\tpindex} -\def\pindex {\pgindex} - -\def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} -{\obeylines % -\gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % -\dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} - -% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. - -% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. -% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). -% -\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup - \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% - % - \smallfonts \rm - \tolerance = 9500 - \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. - % - % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. - % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains - % \initial {@} - % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces - % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). - \catcode`\@ = 11 - \openin 1 \jobname.#1s - \ifeof 1 - % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, - % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the - % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure - % there is some text. - \putwordIndexNonexistent - \else - % - % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof - % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so - % it can discover if there is anything in it. - \read 1 to \temp - \ifeof 1 - \putwordIndexIsEmpty - \else - % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape - % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change - % to make right now. - \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}% - \catcode`\\ = 0 - \escapechar = `\\ - \begindoublecolumns - \input \jobname.#1s - \enddoublecolumns - \fi - \fi - \closein 1 -\endgroup} - -% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. -% Change them to control the appearance of the index. - -\def\initial#1{{% - % Some minor font changes for the special characters. - \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt - % - % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. - \removelastskip - % - % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. - \nobreak - \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip - \penalty 0 - \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip - % - % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of - % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column - % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch - % we need before each entry, but it's better. - % - % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. - \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip - \leftline{\secbf #1}% - % Do our best not to break after the initial. - \nobreak - \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip -}} - -% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and -% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index -% and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. -% -% A straightforward implementation would start like this: -% \def\entry#1#2{... -% But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to -% @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge--- -% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right. -% -% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text. -% --kasal, 21nov03 -\def\entry{% - \begingroup - % - % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't - % affect previous text. - \par - % - % Do not fill out the last line with white space. - \parfillskip = 0in - % - % No extra space above this paragraph. - \parskip = 0in - % - % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. - \finalhyphendemerits = 0 - % - % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number - % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the - % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large - % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across - % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. - % - % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start - % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. - \hangindent = 2em - % - % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line - % with blank space. - \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil - % - % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing - % columns. - \vskip 0pt plus1pt - % - % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter): - \afterassignment\doentry - \let\temp = -} -\def\doentry{% - \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace. - \noindent - \aftergroup\finishentry - % And now comes the text of the entry. -} -\def\finishentry#1{% - % #1 is the page number. - % - % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if - % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be - % cursed by a Unix daemon. - \def\tempa{{\rm }}% - \def\tempb{#1}% - \edef\tempc{\tempa}% - \edef\tempd{\tempb}% - \ifx\tempc\tempd - \ % - \else - % - % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out - % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the - % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) - \hfil\penalty50 - \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. - % - % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as - % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull - % \hbox ensues. - \ifpdf - \pdfgettoks#1.% - \ \the\toksA - \else - \ #1% - \fi - \fi - \par - \endgroup -} - -% Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em. -\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders - \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} - -\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} - -\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm -\def\secondary#1#2{{% - \parfillskip=0in - \parskip=0in - \hangindent=1in - \hangafter=1 - \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill - \ifpdf - \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. - \else - #2 - \fi - \par -}} - -% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. -% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, -% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. -\catcode`\@=11 - -\newbox\partialpage -\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize - -\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns - % Grab any single-column material above us. - \output = {% - % - % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a - % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output - % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is - % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In - % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal - % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this - % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. - \ifvoid\partialpage \else - \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% - \fi - % - \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% - % Unvbox the main output page. - \unvbox\PAGE - \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip - }% - }% - \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage - % - % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. - \output = {\doublecolumnout}% - % - % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this - % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 - % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple - % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the - % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. - % - % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between - % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it - % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant - % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) - % as it did when we hard-coded it. - % - % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we - % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) - % been clobbered. - % - \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize - \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize - \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 - \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize - % - % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, - % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) - \vsize = 2\vsize -} - -% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except -% the last. -% -\def\doublecolumnout{% - \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth - % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal - % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the - % previous page. - \dimen@ = \vsize - \divide\dimen@ by 2 - \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage - % - % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. - \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ - \onepageout\pagesofar - \unvbox255 - \penalty\outputpenalty -} -% -% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, -% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. -\def\pagesofar{% - \unvbox\partialpage - % - \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize - \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize - \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% -} -% -% All done with double columns. -\def\enddoublecolumns{% - \output = {% - % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the - % current page, no automatic page break. - \balancecolumns - % - % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, - % though, there will be another page break right after this \output - % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not - % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal - % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be - % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes - % the output somewhat more palatable.) - \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% - }% - \eject - \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns - % - % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted - % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column - % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the - % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). - \pagegoal = \vsize -} -% -% Called at the end of the double column material. -\def\balancecolumns{% - \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. - \dimen@ = \ht0 - \advance\dimen@ by \topskip - \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip - \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to - %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% - \splittopskip = \topskip - % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. - {% - \vbadness = 10000 - \loop - \global\setbox3 = \copy0 - \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ - \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ - \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt - \repeat - }% - %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% - \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% - \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% - % - \pagesofar -} -\catcode`\@ = \other - - -\message{sectioning,} -% Chapters, sections, etc. - -% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered -% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf -% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter -% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000 -% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) -\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 -\newcount\chapno -\newcount\secno \secno=0 -\newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 -\newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 - -% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... -\newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ -% -% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} -% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple -% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual -% letter in the expansion, not just typeset. -% -\def\appendixletter{% - \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% - \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% - % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is - % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not - % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out - % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. - \else\char\the\appendixno - \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi - \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} - -% Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter. -% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise. -% However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks. -\def\thischapter{} -\def\thissection{} - -\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level -\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count - -% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. -\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} -\let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name - -% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. -\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} -\let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name - -% we only have subsub. -\chardef\maxseclevel = 3 -% -% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too. -% To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in: -\chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel -% -% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not: -% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored. -\def\chapheadtype{N} - -% Choose a heading macro -% #1 is heading type -% #2 is heading level -% #3 is text for heading -\def\genhead#1#2#3{% - % Compute the abs. sec. level: - \absseclevel=#2 - \advance\absseclevel by \secbase - % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range: - \ifnum \absseclevel < 0 - \absseclevel = 0 - \else - \ifnum \absseclevel > 3 - \absseclevel = 3 - \fi - \fi - % The heading type: - \def\headtype{#1}% - \if \headtype U% - \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel - \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel - \fi - \else - % Check for appendix sections: - \ifnum \absseclevel = 0 - \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}% - \else - \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N% - \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}% - \fi\fi - \fi - % Check for numbered within unnumbered: - \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel - \def\headtype{U}% - \else - \chardef\unmlevel = 3 - \fi - \fi - % Now print the heading: - \if \headtype U% - \ifcase\absseclevel - \unnumberedzzz{#3}% - \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}% - \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}% - \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% - \fi - \else - \if \headtype A% - \ifcase\absseclevel - \appendixzzz{#3}% - \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}% - \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}% - \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}% - \fi - \else - \ifcase\absseclevel - \chapterzzz{#3}% - \or \seczzz{#3}% - \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}% - \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% - \fi - \fi - \fi - \suppressfirstparagraphindent -} - -% an interface: -\def\numhead{\genhead N} -\def\apphead{\genhead A} -\def\unnmhead{\genhead U} - -% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset -% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero. -% -% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers -% (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty. -\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty -% -\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz -\def\chapterzzz#1{% - % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such - % as an @include file. - \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 - \global\advance\chapno by 1 - % - % Used for \float. - \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}% - \resetallfloatnos - % - \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}% - % - % Write the actual heading. - \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% - % - % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. - \global\let\section = \numberedsec - \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec - \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec -} - -\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz -\def\appendixzzz#1{% - \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 - \global\advance\appendixno by 1 - \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}% - \resetallfloatnos - % - \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}% - \message{\appendixnum}% - % - \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% - % - \global\let\section = \appendixsec - \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec - \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec -} - -\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz -\def\unnumberedzzz#1{% - \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 - \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1 - % - % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures. - \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty - \resetallfloatnos - % - % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the - % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX - % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX - % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant - % to be executed, not expanded). - % - % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear - % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use - % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, - % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for - % the toc entries.) - \toks0 = {#1}% - \message{(\the\toks0)}% - % - \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% - % - \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec - \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec - \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec -} - -% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. -\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{% - % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break - % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level. - % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04 - \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters - \unnmhead0{#1}% - \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax -} - -% @top is like @unnumbered. -\let\top\unnumbered - -% Sections. -\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz -\def\seczzz#1{% - \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% -} - -\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz -\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% - \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% -} -\let\appendixsec\appendixsection - -\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz -\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% - \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% -} - -% Subsections. -\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz -\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% - \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% -} - -\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz -\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% - \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% - {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% -} - -\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz -\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% - \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% - {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% -} - -% Subsubsections. -\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz -\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% - \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% - {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% -} - -\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz -\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% - \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% - {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% -} - -\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz -\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% - \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 - \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% - {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% -} - -% These macros control what the section commands do, according -% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). -% Define them by default for a numbered chapter. -\let\section = \numberedsec -\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec -\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec - -% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading - -% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such: -% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit -% overlong headings to fold. -% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a -% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it. -% 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and -% if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright. - - -\def\majorheading{% - {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% - \parsearg\chapheadingzzz -} - -\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} -\def\chapheadingzzz#1{% - {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}% - \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax - \suppressfirstparagraphindent -} - -% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. -\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} - \suppressfirstparagraphindent} -\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} - \suppressfirstparagraphindent} -\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} - \suppressfirstparagraphindent} - -% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only -% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), -% given all the information in convenient, parsed form. - -%%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) -\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} - -%%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it -% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) - -\newskip\chapheadingskip - -\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} -\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} -\def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi} - -\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} - -\def\CHAPPAGoff{% -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager -\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak -\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} - -\def\CHAPPAGon{% -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager -\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager -\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager -\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} - -\def\CHAPPAGodd{% -\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage -\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage -\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage -\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} - -\CHAPPAGon - -% Chapter opening. -% -% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, -% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. -% -% To test against our argument. -\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} -\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} -\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} -% -\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{% - \pchapsepmacro - {% - \chapfonts \rm - % - % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the - % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called - % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon. - \gdef\thissection{#1}% - \gdef\thischaptername{#1}% - % - % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix - % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. - \def\temptype{#2}% - \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword - \setbox0 = \hbox{}% - \def\toctype{unnchap}% - \gdef\thischapter{#1}% - \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword - \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry - \def\toctype{omit}% - \gdef\thischapter{}% - \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword - \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% - \def\toctype{app}% - % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter - % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't - % use \thissection because that changes with each section. - % - \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter: - \noexpand\thischaptername}% - \else - \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% - \def\toctype{numchap}% - \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno: - \noexpand\thischaptername}% - \fi\fi\fi - % - % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the - % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc - % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. - \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% - % - % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make - % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has - % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the - % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not - % being visible, for instance under high magnification. - \donoderef{#2}% - % - % Typeset the actual heading. - \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright - \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe - \unhbox0 #1\par}% - }% - \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title - \nobreak -} - -% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. -\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax -\def\centerparameters{% - \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip - \leftskip = \rightskip - \parfillskip = 0pt -} - - -% I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not -% updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03. -% -\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} -% -\def\unnchfopen #1{% -\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt\raggedright - \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak -} -\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts -\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% -\par\penalty 5000 % -} -\def\centerchfopen #1{% -\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000 - \parindent=0pt - \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak -} -\def\CHAPFopen{% - \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen - \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} - - -% Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and -% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. -% -\newskip\secheadingskip -\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} - -% Subsection titles. -\newskip\subsecheadingskip -\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} - -% Subsubsection titles. -\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} -\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} - - -% Print any size, any type, section title. -% -% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is -% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the -% section number. -% -\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% - {% - % Switch to the right set of fonts. - \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm - % - % Insert space above the heading. - \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname - % - % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. - \def\sectionlevel{#2}% - \def\temptype{#3}% - % - \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword - \setbox0 = \hbox{}% - \def\toctype{unn}% - \gdef\thissection{#1}% - \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword - % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, - % and don't redefine \thissection. - \setbox0 = \hbox{}% - \def\toctype{omit}% - \let\sectionlevel=\empty - \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword - \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% - \def\toctype{app}% - \gdef\thissection{#1}% - \else - \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% - \def\toctype{num}% - \gdef\thissection{#1}% - \fi\fi\fi - % - % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chfplain. - \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% - % - % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). - % Again, see comments in \chfplain. - \donoderef{#3}% - % - % Output the actual section heading. - \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright - \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number - \unhbox0 #1}% - }% - % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. - % Don't allow stretch, though. - \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname - % - % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it - % was followed by glue. - \nobreak - % - % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that - % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a - % discardable item.) - \vskip-\parskip - % - % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty > - % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after - % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between: - % - % @section sec-whatever - % @deffn def-whatever - \penalty 10001 -} - - -\message{toc,} -% Table of contents. -\newwrite\tocfile - -% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. -% Called from @chapter, etc. -% -% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} -% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional -% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually -% read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the -% destination to jump to. -% -% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or -% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. -% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the -% table of contents chapter openings themselves. -% -\newif\iftocfileopened -\def\omitkeyword{omit}% -% -\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% - \edef\writetoctype{#1}% - \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else - \iftocfileopened\else - \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc - \global\tocfileopenedtrue - \fi - % - \iflinks - \toks0 = {#2}% - \toks2 = \expandafter{\lastnode}% - \edef\temp{\write\tocfile{\realbackslash #1entry{\the\toks0}{#3}% - {\the\toks2}{\noexpand\folio}}}% - \temp - \fi - \fi - % - % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're - % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't - % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered - % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first - % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named - % `1', and two named `2'. - \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi -} - -\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in -\newcount\savepageno -\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 - -% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. -% -\def\startcontents#1{% - % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should - % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain - % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. - % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se> - \contentsalignmacro - \immediate\closeout\tocfile - % - % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. - % It is abundantly clear what they are. - \def\thischapter{}% - \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% - % - \savepageno = \pageno - \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. - \catcode`\\=0 \catcode`\{=1 \catcode`\}=2 \catcode`\@=11 - % We can't do this, because then an actual ^ in a section - % title fails, e.g., @chapter ^ -- exponentiation. --karl, 9jul97. - %\catcode`\^=7 % to see ^^e4 as \"a etc. juha@piuha.ydi.vtt.fi - \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. - \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. - % - % Roman numerals for page numbers. - \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi -} - - -% Normal (long) toc. -\def\contents{% - \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% - \openin 1 \jobname.toc - \ifeof 1 \else - \input \jobname.toc - \fi - \vfill \eject - \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect - \ifeof 1 \else - \pdfmakeoutlines - \fi - \closein 1 - \endgroup - \lastnegativepageno = \pageno - \global\pageno = \savepageno -} - -% And just the chapters. -\def\summarycontents{% - \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% - % - \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry - \let\appentry = \shortchapentry - \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry - % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. - \secfonts - \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf - \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt - \rm - \hyphenpenalty = 10000 - \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. - \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} - \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry - \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry - \openin 1 \jobname.toc - \ifeof 1 \else - \input \jobname.toc - \fi - \closein 1 - \vfill \eject - \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect - \endgroup - \lastnegativepageno = \pageno - \global\pageno = \savepageno -} -\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents - -% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. -% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. -% -\def\shortchaplabel#1{% - % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the - % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. - % But use \hss just in case. - % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after - % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) - % - % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange - % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and - % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 - % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters - % there are before deciding ... - \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% -} - -% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. -% The first argument is the chapter or section name. -% The last argument is the page number. -% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... - -% Chapters, in the main contents. -\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} -% -% Chapters, in the short toc. -% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. -\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% - \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% -} - -% Appendices, in the main contents. -% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. -% -\def\appendixbox#1{% - % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. - \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% - \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} -% -\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} - -% Unnumbered chapters. -\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} -\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} - -% Sections. -\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} -\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry -\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} - -% Subsections. -\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} -\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry -\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} - -% And subsubsections. -\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} -\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry -\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} - -% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. -% Same as \defaultparindent. -\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt - -% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the -% page number. -% -% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters -% if at all possible; hence the \penalty. -\def\dochapentry#1#2{% - \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip - \begingroup - \chapentryfonts - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% - \endgroup - \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip -} - -\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup - \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% -\endgroup} - -\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup - \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% -\endgroup} - -\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup - \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent - \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% -\endgroup} - -% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries. -\let\tocentry = \entry - -% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. -\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} - -\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} -\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} - -\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} -\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} -\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} -\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} - - -\message{environments,} -% @foo ... @end foo. - -% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. -% -% Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of -% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. -% -\def\point{$\star$} -\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} -\def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} -\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} -\def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} - -% The @error{} command. -% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. -% -\newbox\errorbox -% -{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. -\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules -% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) -\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt} -% -\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil - \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. - \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. - \vbox{% - \hrule height\dimen2 - \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. - \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. - \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. - \hrule height\dimen2} - \hfil} -% -\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} - -% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily. -% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. -% But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character. - -\envdef\tex{% - \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 - \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 - \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie - \catcode `\%=14 - \catcode `\+=\other - \catcode `\"=\other - \catcode `\|=\other - \catcode `\<=\other - \catcode `\>=\other - \escapechar=`\\ - % - \let\b=\ptexb - \let\bullet=\ptexbullet - \let\c=\ptexc - \let\,=\ptexcomma - \let\.=\ptexdot - \let\dots=\ptexdots - \let\equiv=\ptexequiv - \let\!=\ptexexclam - \let\i=\ptexi - \let\indent=\ptexindent - \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent - \let\{=\ptexlbrace - \let\+=\tabalign - \let\}=\ptexrbrace - \let\/=\ptexslash - \let\*=\ptexstar - \let\t=\ptext - % - \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% - \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% - \def\@{@}% -} -% There is no need to define \Etex. - -% Define @lisp ... @end lisp. -% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things, -% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). - -% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. -\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in - -% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other -% such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't -% have any width. -\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} - -% This space is always present above and below environments. -\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt - -% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here -% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip -% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the -% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. -% -\def\aboveenvbreak{{% - % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and - % \sectionheading, q.v. - \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else - \advance\envskipamount by \parskip - \endgraf - \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount - \removelastskip - % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak - % or better ... - \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi - \vskip\envskipamount - \fi - \fi -}} - -\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak - -% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins. -\let\nonarrowing=\relax - -% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around -% environment contents. -\font\circle=lcircle10 -\newdimen\circthick -\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner -\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip -\circthick=\fontdimen8\circle -% -\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth -\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} -\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} -\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} -\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip - \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr - \hskip\rskip}} -\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip - \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr - \hskip\rskip}} -% -\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip - -\envdef\cartouche{% - \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. - \startsavinginserts - \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip - \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*. - \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip - \advance\cartinner by-\rskip - \cartouter=\hsize - \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either - % side, and for 6pt waste from - % each corner char, and rule thickness - \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip - % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin. - \let\nonarrowing=\comment - \vbox\bgroup - \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt - \carttop - \hbox\bgroup - \hskip\lskip - \vrule\kern3pt - \vbox\bgroup - \kern3pt - \hsize=\cartinner - \baselineskip=\normbskip - \lineskip=\normlskip - \parskip=\normpskip - \vskip -\parskip - \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group. -} -\def\Ecartouche{% - \ifhmode\par\fi - \kern3pt - \egroup - \kern3pt\vrule - \hskip\rskip - \egroup - \cartbot - \egroup - \checkinserts -} - - -% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, -% inside a group. -\def\nonfillstart{% - \aboveenvbreak - \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy - \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. - \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines - \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output - \parskip = 0pt - \parindent = 0pt - \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes - % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing - % at next level down. - \ifx\nonarrowing\relax - \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing - \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing - \fi - \let\exdent=\nofillexdent -} - -% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small. -% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall. -% This affects the following displayed environments: -% @example, @display, @format, @lisp -% -\def\smallword{small} -\def\nosmallword{nosmall} -\let\SETdispenvsize\relax -\def\setnormaldispenv{% - \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword - \smallexamplefonts \rm - \fi -} -\def\setsmalldispenv{% - \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword - \else - \smallexamplefonts \rm - \fi -} - -% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo. -% Let's do it by one command: -\def\makedispenv #1#2{ - \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2} - \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2} - \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak - \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak -} - -% Define two synonyms: -\def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{ - \makedispenv{#1}{#3} - \makedispenv{#2}{#3} -} - -% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp. -% -% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. -% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. -% -\maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{% - \nonfillstart - \tt - \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. - \gobble % eat return -} - -% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font. -% -\makedispenv {display}{% - \nonfillstart - \gobble -} - -% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins. -% -\makedispenv{format}{% - \let\nonarrowing = t% - \nonfillstart - \gobble -} - -% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize. -\envdef\flushleft{% - \let\nonarrowing = t% - \nonfillstart - \gobble -} -\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak - -% @flushright. -% -\envdef\flushright{% - \let\nonarrowing = t% - \nonfillstart - \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill - \gobble -} -\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak - - -% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) -% and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since -% we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and -% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0. -% -\envdef\quotation{% - {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip - \parindent=0pt - % - % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. - \ifx\nonarrowing\relax - \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing - \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing - \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing - \let\nonarrowing = \relax - \fi - \parsearg\quotationlabel -} - -% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're -% doing normal filling. -% -\def\Equotation{% - \par - \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else - % indent a bit. - \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}% - \fi - {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% -} - -% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after. -\def\quotationlabel#1{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \ifx\temp\empty \else - {\bf #1: }% - \fi -} - - -% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} -% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, -% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: -% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org -% -% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. -% -% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets -% active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a -% verbatim line. -\def\dospecials{% - \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% - \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% - \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% -} -% -% [Knuth] p. 380 -\def\uncatcodespecials{% - \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials} -% -% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 -% Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font -\begingroup - \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq} -\endgroup -% -% Setup for the @verb command. -% -% Eight spaces for a tab -\begingroup - \catcode`\^^I=\active - \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} -\endgroup -% -\def\setupverb{% - \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim - \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% - \catcode`\`=\active - \tabeightspaces - % Respect line breaks, - % print special symbols as themselves, and - % make each space count - % must do in this order: - \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces -} - -% Setup for the @verbatim environment -% -% Real tab expansion -\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount -% -\def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup} -\begingroup - \catcode`\^^I=\active - \gdef\tabexpand{% - \catcode`\^^I=\active - \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup - \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab - \divide\dimen0 by\tabw - \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw - \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw - \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox - }% - } -\endgroup -\def\setupverbatim{% - \nonfillstart - \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent - % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim - \tt - \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}% - \catcode`\`=\active - \tabexpand - % Respect line breaks, - % print special symbols as themselves, and - % make each space count - % must do in this order: - \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces - \everypar{\starttabbox}% -} - -% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique -% delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a -% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: -% -% \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} -% -% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} -\begingroup - \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other - \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] -\endgroup -% -\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} -% -% -% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that -% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: -% -% \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} -% -% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, -% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': -% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. -% -% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] -% -\begingroup - \catcode`\ =\active - \obeylines % - % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end - % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank - % line in the output. - \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}% - % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but - % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble. -\endgroup -% -\envdef\verbatim{% - \setupverbatim\doverbatim -} -\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak - - -% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. -% -\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude} -% -\def\doverbatiminclude#1{% - {% - \makevalueexpandable - \setupverbatim - \input #1 - \afterenvbreak - }% -} - -% @copying ... @end copying. -% Save the text away for @insertcopying later. -% -% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. -% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the -% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done -% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source -% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as -% possible is very desirable. -% -\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying} -\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}} -% -\def\insertcopying{% - \begingroup - \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page - \scanexp\copyingtext - \endgroup -} - -\message{defuns,} -% @defun etc. - -\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in -\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt -\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt - -% Start the processing of @deffn: -\def\startdefun{% - \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 - \medbreak - \else - % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, - % which is there to keep the function description together with its - % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a - % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted - % by \defargscommonending, instead of 10000, since the sectioning - % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow - % a break between a section heading and a defun. - % - \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi - % - % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. - % But do insert the glue. - \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint - \fi - % - \parindent=0in - \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent - \exdentamount=\defbodyindent -} - -\def\dodefunx#1{% - % First, check whether we are in the right environment: - \checkenv#1% - % - % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row. - % It's not a great place, though. - \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi - % - % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun: - \expandafter\gobbledefun#1% -} -\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{} - -% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text} -% -\def\printdefunline#1#2{% - \begingroup - % call \deffnheader: - #1#2 \endheader - % common ending: - \interlinepenalty = 10000 - \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil - \endgraf - \nobreak\vskip -\parskip - \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx - % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses, - % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize. - \checkparencounts - \endgroup -} - -\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak} - -% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn; -% the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader. -% -\def\makedefun#1{% - \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun - \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun - \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}% - \temp -} - -% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader -% -% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters. -% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly. -% -\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{% - \envdef#1{% - \startdefun - \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}% - }% - \def#2{\dodefunx#1}% - \def#3% -} - -%%% Untyped functions: - -% @deffn category name args -\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}} - -% @deffn category class name args -\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}} - -% \defopon {category on}class name args -\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } - -% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args -% -\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{% - % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}. - \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}% - \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}% -} - -%%% Typed functions: - -% @deftypefn category type name args -\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}} - -% @deftypeop category class type name args -\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}} - -% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args -\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } - -% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args -% -\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% - \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}% - \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% -} - -%%% Typed variables: - -% @deftypevr category type var args -\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}} - -% @deftypecv category class type var args -\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}} - -% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args -\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } - -% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args -% -\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% - \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}% - \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% -} - -%%% Untyped variables: - -% @defvr category var args -\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} } - -% @defcv category class var args -\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}} - -% \defcvof {category of}class var args -\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} } - -%%% Type: -% @deftp category name args -\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{% - \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}% - \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}% -} - -% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts: -\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } -\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} } -\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} } -\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } -\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} } -\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} } -\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} } -\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon} -\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon} -\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} -\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} - -% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). -% #1 is the category, such as "Function". -% #2 is the return type, if any. -% #3 is the function name. -% -% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any. -% -\def\defname#1#2#3{% - % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... - \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent - % - % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps - % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line - % just below it. - \def\temp{#1}% - \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi} - % - % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. - % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero, - % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it: - \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip - % The continuations: - \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent - % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.) - \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2 - % - % Put the type name to the right margin. - \noindent - \hbox to 0pt{% - \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize - % \hsize has to be shortened this way: - \kern\leftskip - % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space. - }% - % - % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: - \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 - \exdentamount=\defbodyindent - {% - % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because: - % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle. - % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's - % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in - % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm. - % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures. - % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no - % one has made identifiers using them :). - \df \tt - \def\temp{#2}% return value type - \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi - #3% output function name - }% - {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm - % - \boldbrax - % arguments will be output next, if any. -} - -% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using -% tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in -% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very -% distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars. -% -\def\defunargs#1{% - % use sl by default (not ttsl), - % tt for the names. - \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0 - % - % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we - % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that. - \let\var=\ttslanted - #1% - \sl\hyphenchar\font=45 -} - -% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. -% -\def\activeparens{% - \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active - \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active - \catcode`\&=\active -} - -% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. -\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) - -% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, -% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, -% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. -{ - \activeparens - \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen - \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack - \global\let& = \& - - \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} - \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm} -} - -\newcount\parencount - -% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards -\newif\ifampseen -\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }} - -\def\parenfont{% - \ifampseen - % At the first level, print parens in roman, - % otherwise use the default font. - \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi - \else - % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than - % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] . - \sf - \fi -} -\def\infirstlevel#1{% - \ifampseen - \ifnum\parencount=1 - #1% - \fi - \fi -} -\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf} - -\def\opnr{% - \global\advance\parencount by 1 - {\parenfont(}% - \infirstlevel \bfafterword -} -\def\clnr{% - {\parenfont)}% - \infirstlevel \sl - \global\advance\parencount by -1 -} - -\newcount\brackcount -\def\lbrb{% - \global\advance\brackcount by 1 - {\bf[}% -} -\def\rbrb{% - {\bf]}% - \global\advance\brackcount by -1 -} - -\def\checkparencounts{% - \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi - \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi -} -\def\badparencount{% - \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}% - \global\parencount=0 -} -\def\badbrackcount{% - \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}% - \global\brackcount=0 -} - - -\message{macros,} -% @macro. - -% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, -% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. -\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined - \newwrite\macscribble - \def\scantokens#1{% - \toks0={#1}% - \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp - \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% - \immediate\closeout\macscribble - \input \jobname.tmp - } -\fi - -\def\scanmacro#1{% - \begingroup - \newlinechar`\^^M - \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces - % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex - % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active - % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had - % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears - % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04 - \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@ - % ... and \example - \spaceisspace - % - % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline. - % - % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX - % --kasal, 29nov03 - \scantokens{#1\endinput}% - \endgroup -} - -\def\scanexp#1{% - \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}% - \temp -} - -\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters -\newtoks\macname % Macro name -\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? -\def\macrolist{} % List of all defined macros in the form - % \do\macro1\do\macro2... - -% Utility routines. -% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is, -% \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname -% (except of course we have to play expansion games). -% -\def\cslet#1#2{% - \expandafter\let - \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname - \csname#2\endcsname -} - -% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. -% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). -{\catcode`\@=11 -\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} -\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} -\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} -\def\unbrace#1{#1} -\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} -} - -% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. -{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% -\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% -\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% -\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% -} - -% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where -% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active -% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \. - -% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is -% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro -% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. - -\def\scanctxt{% - \catcode`\"=\other - \catcode`\+=\other - \catcode`\<=\other - \catcode`\>=\other - \catcode`\@=\other - \catcode`\^=\other - \catcode`\_=\other - \catcode`\|=\other - \catcode`\~=\other -} - -\def\scanargctxt{% - \scanctxt - \catcode`\\=\other - \catcode`\^^M=\other -} - -\def\macrobodyctxt{% - \scanctxt - \catcode`\{=\other - \catcode`\}=\other - \catcode`\^^M=\other - \usembodybackslash -} - -\def\macroargctxt{% - \scanctxt - \catcode`\\=\other -} - -% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. -% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N -% where N is the macro parameter number. -% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so -% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. - -{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active - @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} - @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} -} -\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} - -\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} -\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} - -\def\macroxxx#1{% - \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist - \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments - \paramno=0% - \else - \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% - \fi - \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname - \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% - \else - \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax - \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi - \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% - \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% - % Add the macroname to \macrolist - \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\do}% - \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0 - \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname\endcsname}% - \fi - \begingroup \macrobodyctxt - \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody - \else \expandafter\parsemacbody - \fi} - -\parseargdef\unmacro{% - \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname - \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% - \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% - % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: - \begingroup - \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax - \let\do\unmacrodo - \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% - \endgroup - \else - \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% - \fi -} - -% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any -% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. -% -\def\unmacrodo#1{% - \ifx#1\relax - % remove this - \else - \noexpand\do \noexpand #1% - \fi -} - -% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a -% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by -% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. -\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} -\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} -\def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} -\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} - -% Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist -% so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah -% in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list. -% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). - -% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. -% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something -% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine -% it to # just before using the token list produced. -% -% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before -% the macro is used. - -\def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% - \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,} -\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% - \if#1;\let\next=\relax - \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx - \advance\paramno by 1% - \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname - {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% - \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% - \fi\next} - -% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. -% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) - -\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% -{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% -\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% -{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% - -% This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and -% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments. -% Much magic with \expandafter here. -% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file -% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. -\def\defmacro{% - \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars - \ifrecursive - \ifcase\paramno - % 0 - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% - \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% - \or % 1 - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% - \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt - \noexpand\braceorline - \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% - \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% - \else % many - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% - \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt - \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% - \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% - \expandafter\expandafter - \expandafter\xdef - \expandafter\expandafter - \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname - \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% - \fi - \else - \ifcase\paramno - % 0 - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% - \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% - \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% - \or % 1 - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% - \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt - \noexpand\braceorline - \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% - \egroup - \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% - \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% - \else % many - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% - \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt - \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% - \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% - \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% - \expandafter\expandafter - \expandafter\xdef - \expandafter\expandafter - \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname - \paramlist{% - \egroup - \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% - \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% - \fi - \fi} - -\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} - -% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a -% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole -% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence -% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg) -\def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} -\def\braceorlinexxx{% - \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else - \expandafter\parsearg - \fi \next} - -% We want to disable all macros during \shipout so that they are not -% expanded by \write. -\def\turnoffmacros{\begingroup \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\relax}% - \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} - -% For \indexnofonts, we need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the -% arguments (if present). Of course this is not nearly correct, but it -% is the best we can do for now. makeinfo does not expand macros in the -% argument to @deffn, which ends up writing an index entry, and texindex -% isn't prepared for an index sort entry that starts with \. -% -% Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them -% to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that -% goes to end-of-line is not handled. -% -\def\emptyusermacros{\begingroup - \def\do##1{\let\noexpand##1=\noexpand\asis}% - \edef\next{\macrolist}\expandafter\endgroup\next} - - -% @alias. -% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal -% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing. -\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx} -\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} -\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{% - {% - \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty - \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}% - }% - \next -} - - -\message{cross references,} - -\newwrite\auxfile - -\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. -\newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. - -% @inforef is relatively simple. -\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} -\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, - node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} - -% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in -% cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and -% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like: -% @node foo , bar , ... -% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name. -% -\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse} -% -% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this: -% @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs -\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse} -\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} - -\let\nwnode=\node -\let\lastnode=\empty - -% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the -% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). -% -\def\donoderef#1{% - \ifx\lastnode\empty\else - \setref{\lastnode}{#1}% - \global\let\lastnode=\empty - \fi -} - -% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. -% -\newcount\savesfregister -% -\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} -\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} -\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} - -% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an -% anchor), which consists of three parts: -% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection, -% or the anchor name. -% 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or -% empty for anchors. -% 3) NAME-pg - the page number. -% -% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of -% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here: -% 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats. -% -\def\setref#1#2{% - \pdfmkdest{#1}% - \iflinks - {% - \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them - \turnoffactive - \otherbackslash - \edef\writexrdef##1##2{% - \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef - ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef - }% - \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}% - \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }% - \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc. - \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout - }% - \fi -} - -% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is -% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed -% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed -% manual. All but the node name can be omitted. -% -\def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} -\def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} -\def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} -\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup - \unsepspaces - \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% - \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}% - \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}% - \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}% - \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt - % No printed node name was explicitly given. - \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax - % Use the node name inside the square brackets. - \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% - \else - % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside - % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it. - \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt - % It is in another manual, so we don't have it. - \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% - \else - \ifhavexrefs - % We know the real title if we have the xref values. - \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}% - \else - % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. - \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% - \fi% - \fi - \fi - \fi - % - % Make link in pdf output. - \ifpdf - \leavevmode - \getfilename{#4}% - {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash - \ifnum\filenamelength>0 - \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% - goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{#1}% - \else - \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% - goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}% - \fi - }% - \linkcolor - \fi - % - % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2" - % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the - % LABEL-title being set to a magic string. - {% - % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to - % include an _ in the xref name, etc. - \indexnofonts - \turnoffactive - \otherbackslash - \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle - \csname XR#1-title\endcsname - }% - \iffloat\Xthisreftitle - % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref, - % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2". - \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt - \refx{#1-snt}% - \else - \printedrefname - \fi - % - % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append - % "in MANUALNAME". - \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt - \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% - \fi - \else - % node/anchor (non-float) references. - % - % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not - % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will - % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals - % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this - % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it - % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. - \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt - \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% - \else - % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the - % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand - % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of - % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the - % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. - {\turnoffactive \otherbackslash - % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for - % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. - \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% - \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi - }% - % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden. - \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname - % - % But we always want a comma and a space: - ,\space - % - % output the `page 3'. - \turnoffactive \otherbackslash \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% - \fi - \fi - \endlink -\endgroup} - -% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref -% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, -% since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly -% one that Bob is working on :). -% -\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} - -% Things referred to by \setref. -% -\def\Ynothing{} -\def\Yomitfromtoc{} -\def\Ynumbered{% - \ifnum\secno=0 - \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno - \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 - \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno - \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 - \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno - \else - \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno - \fi\fi\fi -} -\def\Yappendix{% - \ifnum\secno=0 - \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% - \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 - \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno - \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 - \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno - \else - \putwordSection@tie - @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno - \fi\fi\fi -} - -% Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. -% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. -% -\def\refx#1#2{% - {% - \indexnofonts - \otherbackslash - \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX - \csname XR#1\endcsname - }% - \ifx\thisrefX\relax - % If not defined, say something at least. - \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright - \iflinks - \ifhavexrefs - \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}% - \else - \ifwarnedxrefs\else - \global\warnedxrefstrue - \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% - \fi - \fi - \fi - \else - % It's defined, so just use it. - \thisrefX - \fi - #2% Output the suffix in any case. -} - -% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's -% just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid -% collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do. -% -\def\xrdef#1#2{% - \expandafter\gdef\csname XR#1\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref value. - % - % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float? - \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR#1\endcsname - % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype. - \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist - \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname - % - % Is this the first time we've seen this float type? - \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax - \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do - \else - % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list. - \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}% - \fi - % - % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE, - % for later use in \listoffloats. - \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0{#1}}% - \fi -} - -% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. -% -\def\tryauxfile{% - \openin 1 \jobname.aux - \ifeof 1 \else - \readauxfile - \global\havexrefstrue - \fi - \closein 1 -} - -\def\readauxfile{\begingroup - \catcode`\^^@=\other - \catcode`\^^A=\other - \catcode`\^^B=\other - \catcode`\^^C=\other - \catcode`\^^D=\other - \catcode`\^^E=\other - \catcode`\^^F=\other - \catcode`\^^G=\other - \catcode`\^^H=\other - \catcode`\^^K=\other - \catcode`\^^L=\other - \catcode`\^^N=\other - \catcode`\^^P=\other - \catcode`\^^Q=\other - \catcode`\^^R=\other - \catcode`\^^S=\other - \catcode`\^^T=\other - \catcode`\^^U=\other - \catcode`\^^V=\other - \catcode`\^^W=\other - \catcode`\^^X=\other - \catcode`\^^Z=\other - \catcode`\^^[=\other - \catcode`\^^\=\other - \catcode`\^^]=\other - \catcode`\^^^=\other - \catcode`\^^_=\other - % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. - % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't - % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, - % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ - % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat - % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first - % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could - % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. - % - % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: - % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter - % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. - % - \catcode`\^=\other - % - % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... - \catcode`\~=\other - \catcode`\[=\other - \catcode`\]=\other - \catcode`\"=\other - \catcode`\_=\other - \catcode`\|=\other - \catcode`\<=\other - \catcode`\>=\other - \catcode`\$=\other - \catcode`\#=\other - \catcode`\&=\other - \catcode`\%=\other - \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off - % - % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \ - % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than - % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \ - % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value* - % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that - % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for - % now. --karl, 15jan04. - \catcode`\\=\other - % - % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters. - {% - \count 1=128 - \def\loop{% - \catcode\count 1=\other - \advance\count 1 by 1 - \ifnum \count 1<256 \loop \fi - }% - }% - % - % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces. - \catcode`\{=1 - \catcode`\}=2 - \catcode`\@=0 - % - \input \jobname.aux -\endgroup} - - -\message{insertions,} -% including footnotes. - -\newcount \footnoteno - -% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is -% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a -% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is -% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a -% space to prevent strange expansion errors.) -\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } - -% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only. -\let\footnotestyle=\comment - -{\catcode `\@=11 -% -% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. -\gdef\footnote{% - \let\indent=\ptexindent - \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent - \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne - \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% - % - % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the - % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. - \let\@sf\empty - \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi - % - % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. - \unskip - \thisfootno\@sf - \dofootnote -}% - -% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the -% footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. -% -% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses -% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when -% the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. -% -\gdef\dofootnote{% - \insert\footins\bgroup - % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the - % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. - % So reset some parameters. - \hsize=\pagewidth - \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty - \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes - \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox - \floatingpenalty\@MM - \leftskip\z@skip - \rightskip\z@skip - \spaceskip\z@skip - \xspaceskip\z@skip - \parindent\defaultparindent - % - \smallfonts \rm - % - % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears - % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use - % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote - % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). - \let\noindent = \relax - % - % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the - % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. - \everypar = {\hang}% - \textindent{\thisfootno}% - % - % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this - % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it - % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. - \footstrut - \futurelet\next\fo@t -} -}%end \catcode `\@=11 - -% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create -% the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion -% would be lost. -% Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote -% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished. -% And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03. - -% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro. -% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled -% out prematurely. -% -\def\startsavinginserts{% - \ifx \insert\ptexinsert - \let\insert\saveinsert - \else - \let\checkinserts\relax - \fi -} - -% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and -% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}. -% -\def\saveinsert#1{% - \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}% - \afterassignment\next - % swallow the left brace - \let\temp = -} -\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}} -\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1} - -\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi} - -\def\placesaveins#1{% - \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname - {\box#1}% -} - -% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other: -{ - \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-) - \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{} -} - -% initialization: -\def\newsaveins #1{% - \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}% - \next -} -\def\newsaveinsX #1{% - \csname newbox\endcsname #1% - \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts - \checksaveins #1}% -} - -% initialize: -\let\checkinserts\empty -\newsaveins\footins -\newsaveins\margin - - -% @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. -% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. -% -% Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image -% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get -% undone and the next image would fail. -\openin 1 = epsf.tex -\ifeof 1 \else - % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in - % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). - \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% - \input epsf.tex -\fi -\closein 1 -% -% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. -\newif\ifwarnednoepsf -\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to - work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get - it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} -% -\def\image#1{% - \ifx\epsfbox\undefined - \ifwarnednoepsf \else - \errhelp = \noepsfhelp - \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% - \global\warnednoepsftrue - \fi - \else - \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish - \fi -} -% -% Arguments to @image: -% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. -% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. -% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. -% #5 is (ignored optional) extension. -% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff. -\newif\ifimagevmode -\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup - \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example - \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names - % If the image is by itself, center it. - \ifvmode - \imagevmodetrue - \nobreak\bigskip - % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert - % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space - % above and below. - \nobreak\vskip\parskip - \nobreak - \line\bgroup\hss - \fi - % - % Output the image. - \ifpdf - \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% - \else - % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi - \epsfbox{#1.eps}% - \fi - % - \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image -\endgroup} - - -% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables, -% etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the -% float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future. -% -\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish} - -% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it. -\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,} - -% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically -% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted, -% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to. -% -% #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to -% be referable. -% -% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It -% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom). -% -% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each -% chapter-level command. -\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty -% -\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% - \let\thiscaption=\empty - \let\thisshortcaption=\empty - % - % don't lose footnotes inside @float. - % - % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an - % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04 - % - \startsavinginserts - % - % We can't be used inside a paragraph. - \par - % - \vtop\bgroup - \def\floattype{#1}% - \def\floatlabel{#2}% - \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet. - % - \ifx\floattype\empty - \let\safefloattype=\empty - \else - {% - % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, - % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. - \indexnofonts - \turnoffactive - \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% - }% - \fi - % - % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type. - \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else - % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1, - % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.) - % - \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname - \global\advance\floatno by 1 - % - {% - % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the - % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float - % labels (which have a completely different output format) from - % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the - % lists of floats. - % - \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}% - \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}% - }% - \fi - % - % start with \parskip glue, I guess. - \vskip\parskip - % - % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section. - \restorefirstparagraphindent -} - -% we have these possibilities: -% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap -% @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1 -% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap -% @float Foo & no caption: Foo -% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap -% @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1 -% @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap -% @float & no caption: -% -\def\Efloat{% - \let\floatident = \empty - % - % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first. - \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi - % - % If we have an xref label, the number comes next. - \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else - \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first. - \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}% - \fi - % the number. - \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% - \fi - % - % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in - % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again. - \let\captionline = \floatident - % - \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else - \ifx\floatident\empty \else - \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between - \fi - % - % caption text. - \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}% - \fi - % - % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before. - % Eventually this needs to become an \insert. - \ifx\captionline\empty \else - \vskip.5\parskip - \captionline - % - % Space below caption. - \vskip\parskip - \fi - % - % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this - % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint. - \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else - % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as - % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short - % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing. - {% - \atdummies \turnoffactive \otherbackslash - % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M - % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so - % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file. - \scanexp{% - \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{% - \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty - \thiscaption - \else - \thisshortcaption - \fi - }% - }% - \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident - \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}% - }% - \fi - \egroup % end of \vtop - % - % place the captured inserts - % - % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an - % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04 - % - \checkinserts -} - -% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either. -% -\def\appendtomacro#1#2{% - \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}% -} - -% @caption, @shortcaption -% -\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption} -\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption} -\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption} -\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}} - -% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are -% going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno. -\def\getfloatno#1{% - \ifx#1\relax - % Haven't seen this figure type before. - \csname newcount\endcsname #1% - % - % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap. - \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos - \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }% - \fi - \let\floatno#1% -} - -% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref -% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we -% first read the @float command. -% -\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% - -% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can -% distinguish floats from other xref types. -\def\floatmagic{!!float!!} - -% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional -% which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic -% \thissection value which we \setref above. -% -\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish} -% -% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the -% (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2. -% -\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{% - \def\temp{#1}% - \def\iffloattype{#2}% - \ifx\temp\floatmagic -} - -% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents. -% -\parseargdef\listoffloats{% - \def\floattype{#1}% floattype - {% - % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, - % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. - \indexnofonts - \turnoffactive - \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% - }% - % - % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE. - \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax - \ifhavexrefs - % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo. - \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}% - \fi - \else - \begingroup - \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc - \let\do=\listoffloatsdo - \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname - \endgroup - \fi -} - -% This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the -% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the -% aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which -% has the text we're supposed to typeset here. -% -% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since -% they won't appear in the aux file). -% -\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish} -\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{% - % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just - % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the - % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link - % in pdf output. - \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}% - % - % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index. - \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}% - \writeentry -}} - -\message{localization,} -% and i18n. - -% @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after -% @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything -% properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation. -% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here. -% -\parseargdef\documentlanguage{% - \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. - % Read the file if it exists. - \openin 1 txi-#1.tex - \ifeof 1 - \errhelp = \nolanghelp - \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% - \else - \input txi-#1.tex - \fi - \closein 1 - \endgroup -} -\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or -is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory -should work if nowhere else does.} - - -% @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most -% likely, but for now just recognize it. -\let\documentencoding = \comment - - -% Page size parameters. -% -\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt - -\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt -\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt -\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt - -% Prevent underfull vbox error messages. -\vbadness = 10000 - -% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either. -\hbadness = 2000 - -% Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans. -\widowpenalty=10000 -\clubpenalty=10000 - -% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're -% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of -% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on -% \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. -% -\def\setemergencystretch{% - \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined - % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. - \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% - \else - \emergencystretch = .15\hsize - \fi -} - -% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; 3) voffset; -% 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; 7) physical page height; 8) -% physical page width. -% -% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define -% \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. -% -\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% - \voffset = #3\relax - \topskip = #6\relax - \splittopskip = \topskip - % - \vsize = #1\relax - \advance\vsize by \topskip - \outervsize = \vsize - \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin - \pageheight = \vsize - % - \hsize = #2\relax - \outerhsize = \hsize - \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in - \pagewidth = \hsize - % - \normaloffset = #4\relax - \bindingoffset = #5\relax - % - \ifpdf - \pdfpageheight #7\relax - \pdfpagewidth #8\relax - \fi - % - \setleading{\textleading} - % - \parindent = \defaultparindent - \setemergencystretch -} - -% @letterpaper (the default). -\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 - \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt - \textleading = 13.2pt - % - % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. - \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}% - {\voffset}{.25in}% - {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% - {11in}{8.5in}% -}} - -% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.5 (or so) format. -\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 - \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt - \textleading = 12pt - % - \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% - {\voffset}{.25in}% - {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% - {9.25in}{7in}% - % - \lispnarrowing = 0.3in - \tolerance = 700 - \hfuzz = 1pt - \contentsrightmargin = 0pt - \defbodyindent = .5cm -}} - -% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. -\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 - \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt - \textleading = 13.2pt - % - % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 - % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. - % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust - % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then - % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in - % your texinfo source file like this: - % @tex - % \global\normaloffset = -6mm - % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm - % @end tex - \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm} - {\voffset}{\hoffset}% - {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% - {297mm}{210mm}% - % - \tolerance = 700 - \hfuzz = 1pt - \contentsrightmargin = 0pt - \defbodyindent = 5mm -}} - -% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. -% From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. -% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. -\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 - \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt - \textleading = 12.5pt - % - \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% - {\voffset}{\hoffset}% - {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% - {210mm}{148mm}% - % - \lispnarrowing = 0.2in - \tolerance = 800 - \hfuzz = 1.2pt - \contentsrightmargin = 0pt - \defbodyindent = 2mm - \tableindent = 12mm -}} - -% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. -\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 - \afourpaper - \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% - {\voffset}{4.6mm}% - {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% - {297mm}{210mm}% - % - % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. - \globaldefs = 0 -}} - -% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. -\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 - \afourpaper - \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% - {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% - {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% - {297mm}{210mm}% - \globaldefs = 0 -}} - -% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] -% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, -% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. -% -\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} -\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% - \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi - \globaldefs = 1 - % - \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt - \setleading{\textleading}% - % - \dimen0 = #1 - \advance\dimen0 by \voffset - % - \dimen2 = \hsize - \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset - % - \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% - {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% - {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% - {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% -}} - -% Set default to letter. -% -\letterpaper - - -\message{and turning on texinfo input format.} - -% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. -\catcode`\"=\other -\catcode`\~=\other -\catcode`\^=\other -\catcode`\_=\other -\catcode`\|=\other -\catcode`\<=\other -\catcode`\>=\other -\catcode`\+=\other -\catcode`\$=\other -\def\normaldoublequote{"} -\def\normaltilde{~} -\def\normalcaret{^} -\def\normalunderscore{_} -\def\normalverticalbar{|} -\def\normalless{<} -\def\normalgreater{>} -\def\normalplus{+} -\def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix - -% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt -% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts, -% where something hairier probably needs to be done. -% -% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print -% otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero -% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all -% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. -% -\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} - -% Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches -% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from -% italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway -% this is not a problem. -\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} - -% Turn off all special characters except @ -% (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). -% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can -% use math or other variants that look better in normal text. - -\catcode`\"=\active -\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} -\let"=\activedoublequote -\catcode`\~=\active -\def~{{\tt\char126}} -\chardef\hat=`\^ -\catcode`\^=\active -\def^{{\tt \hat}} - -\catcode`\_=\active -\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} -% Subroutine for the previous macro. -\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } - -\catcode`\|=\active -\def|{{\tt\char124}} -\chardef \less=`\< -\catcode`\<=\active -\def<{{\tt \less}} -\chardef \gtr=`\> -\catcode`\>=\active -\def>{{\tt \gtr}} -\catcode`\+=\active -\def+{{\tt \char 43}} -\catcode`\$=\active -\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix - -% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file -% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. -% So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. -% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. -\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} - -\catcode`\@=0 - -% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font, -% as in \char`\\. -\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\ -\global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work - -% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont. -% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with -% catcode other. -{\catcode`\\=\active - @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont} - @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} -} - -% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other. -{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\}} - -% \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font. -\def\normalbackslash{{\tt\backslashcurfont}} - -\catcode`\\=\active - -% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters -% even after parsing them. -@def@turnoffactive{% - @let"=@normaldoublequote - @let\=@realbackslash - @let~=@normaltilde - @let^=@normalcaret - @let_=@normalunderscore - @let|=@normalverticalbar - @let<=@normalless - @let>=@normalgreater - @let+=@normalplus - @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix - @unsepspaces -} - -% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of -% the literal character `\'. (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in -% effect.) -% -@def@normalturnoffactive{@turnoffactive @let\=@normalbackslash} - -% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. -% This is canceled by @fixbackslash. -@otherifyactive - -% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. -% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing -% a backslash. -% -@gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} -@global@let\ = @eatinput - -% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then -% the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix -% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. -% Also back turn on active characters that might appear in the input -% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. -% -@gdef@fixbackslash{% - @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi - @catcode`+=@active - @catcode`@_=@active -} - -% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. -@escapechar = `@@ - -% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. -@catcode`@& = @other -@catcode`@# = @other -@catcode`@% = @other - - -@c Local variables: -@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) -@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" -@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" -@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" -@c time-stamp-end: "}" -@c End: - -@c vim:sw=2: - -@ignore - arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115 -@end ignore diff --git a/isisd/Makefile.am b/isisd/Makefile.am index 9c303390..a7117fd6 100644 --- a/isisd/Makefile.am +++ b/isisd/Makefile.am @@ -2,7 +2,6 @@ INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib \ @ISIS_TOPOLOGY_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 LIBS = @LIBS@ diff --git a/isisd/isis_main.c b/isisd/isis_main.c index c5e824c1..d457d25e 100644 --- a/isisd/isis_main.c +++ b/isisd/isis_main.c @@ -34,6 +34,7 @@ #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" #include "filter.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "isisd/dict.h" #include "include-netbsd/iso.h" @@ -45,7 +46,10 @@ #include "isisd/isis_dynhn.h" /* Default configuration file name */ -#define ISISD_DEFAULT_CONFIG "isisd.conf" +#define ISISD_CONFIG_NAME "isisd.conf" +#define ISISD_PID_NAME "isisd.pid" +#define ISISD_VTY_NAME "isisd.vty" + /* Default vty port */ #define ISISD_VTY_PORT 2608 @@ -73,6 +77,7 @@ struct zebra_privs_t isisd_privs = { /* isisd options */ struct option longopts[] = { {"daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + {"namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, {"config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, {"pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, {"vty_addr", required_argument, NULL, 'A'}, @@ -86,7 +91,7 @@ struct option longopts[] = { }; /* Configuration file and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR ISISD_DEFAULT_CONFIG; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; char *config_file = NULL; /* isisd program name. */ @@ -97,8 +102,11 @@ int daemon_mode = 0; /* Master of threads. */ struct thread_master *master; +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_ISISD_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* for reload */ char _cwd[MAXPATHLEN]; @@ -128,6 +136,7 @@ usage (int status) printf ("Usage : %s [OPTION...]\n\n\ Daemon which manages IS-IS routing\n\n\ -d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n\ +-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n\ -f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n\ -i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n\ -A, --vty_addr Set vty's bind address\n\ @@ -246,7 +255,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **envp) /* Command line argument treatment. */ while (1) { - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "df:i:hA:p:P:u:g:vC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "dN:f:i:hA:p:P:u:g:vC", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -258,6 +267,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **envp) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'f': config_file = optarg; break; @@ -303,6 +315,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **envp) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (ISISD_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (ISISD_PID_NAME)); + /* thread master */ master = thread_master_create (); @@ -343,7 +358,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **envp) pid_output (pid_file); /* Make isis vty socket. */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, ISIS_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (ISISD_VTY_NAME)); /* Print banner. */ zlog_notice ("Quagga-ISISd %s starting: vty@%d", QUAGGA_VERSION, vty_port); diff --git a/lib/Makefile.am b/lib/Makefile.am index 315e919b..1b4134dc 100644 --- a/lib/Makefile.am +++ b/lib/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" +DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" -DPATH_CONFIG=\"$(sysconfdir)\" lib_LTLIBRARIES = libzebra.la libzebra_la_LDFLAGS = -version-info 0:0:0 @@ -12,13 +12,13 @@ libzebra_la_SOURCES = \ sockunion.c prefix.c thread.c if.c memory.c buffer.c table.c hash.c \ filter.c routemap.c distribute.c stream.c str.c log.c plist.c \ zclient.c sockopt.c smux.c md5.c if_rmap.c keychain.c privs.c \ - sigevent.c pqueue.c jhash.c memtypes.c workqueue.c + sigevent.c pqueue.c jhash.c memtypes.c workqueue.c paths.c BUILT_SOURCES = memtypes.h route_types.h libzebra_la_DEPENDENCIES = @LIB_REGEX@ -libzebra_la_LIBADD = @LIB_REGEX@ +libzebra_la_LIBADD = @LIB_REGEX@ @LIBCAP@ pkginclude_HEADERS = \ buffer.h checksum.h command.h filter.h getopt.h hash.h \ @@ -27,12 +27,12 @@ pkginclude_HEADERS = \ str.h stream.h table.h thread.h vector.h version.h vty.h zebra.h \ plist.h zclient.h sockopt.h smux.h md5.h if_rmap.h keychain.h \ privs.h sigevent.h pqueue.h jhash.h zassert.h memtypes.h \ - workqueue.h route_types.h + workqueue.h route_types.h paths.h -EXTRA_DIST = regex.c regex-gnu.h memtypes.awk route_types.awk route_types.txt +EXTRA_DIST = regex.c regex-gnu.h memtypes.awk route_types.pl route_types.txt memtypes.h: $(srcdir)/memtypes.c $(srcdir)/memtypes.awk ($(GAWK) -f $(srcdir)/memtypes.awk $(srcdir)/memtypes.c > $@) -route_types.h: $(srcdir)/route_types.txt $(srcdir)/route_types.awk - ($(GAWK) -f $(srcdir)/route_types.awk $(srcdir)/route_types.txt > $@) +route_types.h: $(srcdir)/route_types.txt $(srcdir)/route_types.pl + @PERL@ $(srcdir)/route_types.pl < $(srcdir)/route_types.txt > $@ diff --git a/lib/command.c b/lib/command.c index 478125f2..f65a87d0 100644 --- a/lib/command.c +++ b/lib/command.c @@ -84,9 +84,9 @@ static struct cmd_node config_node = /* Default motd string. */ static const char *default_motd = "\r\n\ -Hello, this is " QUAGGA_PROGNAME " (version " QUAGGA_VERSION ").\r\n\ -" QUAGGA_COPYRIGHT "\r\n\ -\r\n"; +This is " QUAGGA_PROGNAME " " QUAGGA_VERSION "\r\n\r\n\ +You're using the dn42 branch. Send bug reports to equinox@diac24.net\r\n\ +The 1.1.0 version number is for package management purposes only.\r\n"; static const struct facility_map { @@ -172,6 +172,12 @@ struct connected /* Label for Linux 2.2.X and upper. */ char *label; + + /* scope value, Linux only */ + unsigned scope; + + /* address preference, NetBSD >=4.0 with option IPSRCSEL, in_getifa(9) */ + int preference; }; /* Does the destination field contain a peer address? */ @@ -22,6 +22,8 @@ * 02111-1307, USA. */ +#define QUAGGA_DEFINE_DESC_TABLE + #include <zebra.h> #include "log.h" @@ -759,7 +761,7 @@ lookup (const struct message *mes, int key) { const struct message *pnt; - for (pnt = mes; pnt->key != 0; pnt++) + for (pnt = mes; pnt->str; pnt++) if (pnt->key == key) return pnt->str; @@ -815,29 +817,6 @@ safe_strerror(int errnum) return (s != NULL) ? s : "Unknown error"; } -struct zebra_desc_table -{ - unsigned int type; - const char *string; - char chr; -}; - -#define DESC_ENTRY(T,S,C) [(T)] = { (T), (S), (C) } -static const struct zebra_desc_table route_types[] = { - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_SYSTEM, "system", 'X' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL, "kernel", 'K' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT, "connected", 'C' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC, "static", 'S' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP, "rip", 'R' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG, "ripng", 'R' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF, "ospf", 'O' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6, "ospf6", 'O' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS, "isis", 'I' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP, "bgp", 'B' ), - DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_ROUTE_HSLS, "hsls", 'H' ), -}; -#undef DESC_ENTRY - #define DESC_ENTRY(T) [(T)] = { (T), (#T), '\0' } static const struct zebra_desc_table command_types[] = { DESC_ENTRY (ZEBRA_INTERFACE_ADD), @@ -927,4 +906,58 @@ proto_name2num(const char *s) return route_types[i].type; return -1; } + #undef RTSIZE + +int +proto_redistnum(int afi, const char *s) +{ + if (! s) + return -1; + + if (afi == AFI_IP) + { + if (strncmp (s, "k", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; + else if (strncmp (s, "c", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; + else if (strncmp (s, "s", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; + else if (strncmp (s, "r", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP; + else if (strncmp (s, "os", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF; + else if (strncmp (s, "i", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS; + else if (strncmp (s, "bg", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; + else if (strncmp (s, "ol", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_OLSR; + else if (strncmp (s, "ba", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_BATMAN; + else if (strncmp (s, "d", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_DHCP; + } + if (afi == AFI_IP6) + { + if (strncmp (s, "k", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; + else if (strncmp (s, "c", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; + else if (strncmp (s, "s", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; + else if (strncmp (s, "r", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG; + else if (strncmp (s, "os", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6; + else if (strncmp (s, "i", 1) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS; + else if (strncmp (s, "bg", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; + else if (strncmp (s, "ol", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_OLSR; + else if (strncmp (s, "ba", 2) == 0) + return ZEBRA_ROUTE_BATMAN; + } + return -1; +} diff --git a/lib/paths.c b/lib/paths.c new file mode 100644 index 00000000..5678b873 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/paths.c @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/* + * Path helper functions (for namespaces) + * Copyright (C) 2009 David Lamparter + * + * This file is part of GNU Zebra. + * + * GNU Zebra is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify + * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published + * by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your + * option) any later version. + * + * GNU Zebra is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but + * WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + * General Public License for more details. + * + * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + * along with GNU Zebra; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the + * Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, + * Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. + */ + +#include <zebra.h> +#include <log.h> +#include <paths.h> + +static char *namespace = ""; + +void path_set_namespace(const char *ns) +{ + size_t len; + + if (*namespace) + free(namespace); + if (!ns || !*ns) { + namespace = ""; + return; + } + + len = strlen(ns); + namespace = malloc(len + 2); + if (!namespace) { /* ugh... */ + namespace = ""; + return; + }; + namespace[0] = '/'; + memcpy(namespace + 1, ns, len + 1); +} + +const char *path_state(const char *filename) +{ + static char buf[MAXPATHLEN]; + snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s%s/%s", + PATH_STATE, namespace, filename); + return buf; +} + +const char *path_config(const char *filename) +{ + static char buf[MAXPATHLEN]; + snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%s%s/%s", + PATH_CONFIG, namespace, filename); + return buf; +} + diff --git a/lib/paths.h b/lib/paths.h new file mode 100644 index 00000000..1f697855 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/paths.h @@ -0,0 +1,34 @@ +/* + * Path helper functions (for namespaces) + * Copyright (C) 2009 David Lamparter + * + * This file is part of GNU Zebra. + * + * GNU Zebra is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify + * it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published + * by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your + * option) any later version. + * + * GNU Zebra is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but + * WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of + * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU + * General Public License for more details. + * + * You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License + * along with GNU Zebra; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the + * Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, + * Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. + */ + +#ifndef _ZEBRA_PATHS_H +#define _ZEBRA_PATHS_H + +extern void path_set_namespace(const char *ns); + +/* the following two functions return pointers to a _static_ buffer! + * if you need to keep a reference to the values, do a strdup + */ +extern const char *path_state(const char *filename); +extern const char *path_config(const char *filename); + +#endif /* _ZEBRA_PATHS_H */ diff --git a/lib/route_types.awk b/lib/route_types.awk deleted file mode 100644 index eb3d382a..00000000 --- a/lib/route_types.awk +++ /dev/null @@ -1,187 +0,0 @@ -# $Id$ -# -# Scan a file of route-type definitions (see eg route_types.txt) and -# generate a corresponding header file with: -# -# - enum of Zserv route-types -# - redistribute strings for the various Quagga daemons -# -# See route_types.txt for the format. -# -# - -BEGIN { - FS="[,]"; - - # globals - exitret = 0; - tcount = 0; - - # formats for output - ## the define format - redist_def_fmt = "#define QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_%s \\\n"; - ## DEFUN/vty route-type argument - redist_str_fmt = "\"(%s)\"\n"; - redist_help_def_fmt = "#define QUAGGA_REDIST_HELP_STR_%s"; - redist_help_str_fmt = " \\\n \"%s\\n\""; - - # header - header = "/* Auto-generated from route_types.txt by " ARGV[0] ". */\n"; - header = header "/* Do not edit! */\n"; - header = header "\n#ifndef _QUAGGA_ROUTE_TYPES_H\n"; - header = header "#define _QUAGGA_ROUTE_TYPES_H\n"; - footer = "#endif /* _QUAGGA_ROUTE_TYPES_H */\n"; - printf ("%s\n", header); -} - -# Chomp comment lines -($0 ~ /^#/) { - next; -} - -# get rid of the commas, leading/trailling whitespace and -# quotes -{ - for (i = 1; i <= NF; i++) { - #print "before:" $i; - $i = gensub(/^[[:blank:]]*(.*)[,]*.*/, "\\1", "g",$i); - $i = gensub(/^["](.*)["]$/, "\\1", "g", $i); - #print "after :" $i; - } -} - -# 7 field format: -# type cname daemon C 4 6 short help -(NF >= 7) { - #print "7", $1, $0; - - if ($1 in types) { - print "error: attempt to redefine", $1; - exitret = 1; - exit exitret; - } - - typesbynum[tcount] = $1; - types[$1,"num"] = tcount++; - types[$1,"cname"] = $2; - types[$1,"daemon"] = $3; - types[$1,"C"] = $4; - types[$1,"4"] = strtonum($5); - types[$1,"6"] = strtonum($6); - types[$1,"shelp"] = $7; - - #print "num :", types[$1,"num"] - #print "cname :", types[$1,"cname"] - #print "daemon:", types[$1,"daemon"]; - #print "char :", types[$1,"C"]; -}; - -# 2 field: type "long description" -(NF == 2) { - #print "2", $1, $2; - - if (!(($1 SUBSEP "num") in types)) { - print "error: type", $1, "must be defined before help str"; - exitret = 2; - exit exitret; - } - - types[$1,"lhelp"] = $2; -} - -END { - if (exitret) - exit exitret; - - # The enums - # not yet... - #printf("enum\n{\n"); - #for (i = 0; i < tcount; i++) { - # type = typesbynum[i]; - # if (type != "" && types[type,"num"] == i) - # printf (" %s,\n", type); - #} - #printf (" ZEBRA_ROUTE_MAX,\n};\n\n"); - - # the redistribute defines - for (i = 0; i < tcount; i++) { - type = typesbynum[i]; - - # must be a type, and must cross-check against recorded type - if (type == "" || types[type,"num"] != i) - continue; - - # ignore route types that can't be redistributed - if (!(types[type,"4"] || types[type,"6"])) - continue; - - # must have a daemon name - if (!((type SUBSEP "daemon") in types)) - continue; - if (!(daemon = types[type,"daemon"])) - continue; - - # might have done this daemon already? - if (daemon in seen_daemons) - continue; - - cname = types[type,"cname"]; - all = all "|" cname; - rstr = ""; - hstr = ""; - - # add it to the others - for (j = 0; j < tcount; j++) { - # ignore self - if (i == j) - continue; - - type2 = typesbynum[j]; - - # type2 must be valid, and self-check. - if (type2 == "" || types[type2,"num"] != j) - continue; - - # ignore different route types for the same daemon - # (eg system/kernel/connected) - if (types[type2,"daemon"] == daemon) - continue; - - if ((types[type2,"4"] && types[type,"4"]) \ - || (types[type2,"6"] && types[type,"6"])) { - - if (rstr == "") - rstr = types[type2,"cname"]; - else - rstr = rstr "|" types[type2,"cname"]; - - if ((type2 SUBSEP "lhelp") in types) - hstr2 = types[type2,"lhelp"]; - else if ((type2 SUBSEP "shelp") in types) - hstr2 = types[type2,"shelp"]; - else - hstr2 = types[type2,"cname"]; - - hstr = hstr sprintf(redist_help_str_fmt, hstr2); - } - } - - # dont double-process daemons. - seen_daemons[daemon] = 1; - - printf("/* %s */\n", daemon); - printf(redist_def_fmt, toupper(daemon)); - printf(redist_str_fmt, rstr); - printf(redist_help_def_fmt, toupper(daemon)); - printf("%s", hstr); - printf("\n\n"); - } - - #printf("#define QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_ALL %s\n",all); - -# for (i = 0; i < lcount; i++) { -# if (mlists[i] != "") -# printf (mlistformat "\n", mlists[i]); -# } - printf (footer); -} diff --git a/lib/route_types.pl b/lib/route_types.pl new file mode 100755 index 00000000..e1595afc --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/route_types.pl @@ -0,0 +1,199 @@ +#!/usr/bin/perl +## +## Scan a file of route-type definitions (see eg route_types.txt) and +## generate a corresponding header file with: +## +## - enum of Zserv route-types +## - redistribute strings for the various Quagga daemons +## +## See route_types.txt for the format. +## +## +## Copyright (C) 2009 David Lamparter. +## This file is part of GNU Zebra. +## +## GNU Zebra is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it +## under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the +## Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any +## later version. +## +## GNU Zebra is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but +## WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of +## MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU +## General Public License for more details. +## +## You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License +## along with GNU Zebra; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free +## Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA +## 02111-1307, USA. +## + +use strict; + +# input processing +# +my @protos; +my %protodetail; + +my %daemons; + +while (<STDIN>) { + # skip comments and empty lines + next if (/^\s*(#|$)/); + + # strip whitespace + chomp; + $_ =~ s/^\s*//; + $_ =~ s/\s*$//; + + # match help strings + if (/^(ZEBRA_ROUTE_[^\s]+)\s*,\s*"(.*)"$/) { + $protodetail{$1}->{'longhelp'} = $2; + next; + } + + $_ =~ s/\s*,\s*/,/g; + + # else: 7-field line + my @f = split(/,/, $_); + unless (@f == 7) { + die "invalid input on route_types line $.\n"; + } + + my $proto = $f[0]; + $f[3] = $1 if ($f[3] =~ /^'(.*)'$/); + $f[6] = $1 if ($f[6] =~ /^"(.*)"$/); + + $protodetail{$proto} = { + "number" => scalar @protos, + "type" => $f[0], + "cname" => $f[1], + "daemon" => $f[2], + "char" => $f[3], + "ipv4" => int($f[4]), + "ipv6" => int($f[5]), + "shorthelp" => $f[6], + }; + push @protos, $proto; + $daemons{$f[2]} = { + "ipv4" => int($f[4]), + "ipv6" => int($f[5]) + } unless ($f[2] eq "NULL"); +} + +# output +printf <<EOF, $ARGV[0]; +/* Auto-generated from route_types.txt by %s. */ +/* Do not edit! */ + +#ifndef _QUAGGA_ROUTE_TYPES_H +#define _QUAGGA_ROUTE_TYPES_H + +/* Zebra route's types. */ +EOF + +push @protos, "ZEBRA_ROUTE_MAX"; +my (@protosv4, @protosv6) = ((), ()); +for (my $c = 0; $c < @protos; $c++) { + my $p = $protos[$c]; + printf "#define %-32s %d\n", $p, $c; + push @protosv4, $p if ($protodetail{$p}->{"ipv4"}); + push @protosv6, $p if ($protodetail{$p}->{"ipv6"}); +} +pop @protos; + +sub codelist { + my (@protos) = @_; + my (@lines) = (); + my $str = " \"Codes: "; + for my $p (@protos) { + my $s = sprintf("%s - %s, ", + $protodetail{$p}->{"char"}, + $protodetail{$p}->{"shorthelp"}); + if (length($str . $s) > 70) { + $str =~ s/ $//; + push @lines, $str . "%s\" \\\n"; + $str = " \" "; + } + $str .= $s; + } + $str =~ s/ $//; + push @lines, $str . "%s\" \\\n"; + push @lines, " \" > - selected route, * - FIB route%s%s\", \\\n"; + my @nl = (); + for (my $c = 0; $c < @lines + 1; $c++) { + push @nl, "VTY_NEWLINE" + } + return join("", @lines) ." ". join(", ", @nl); +} + +print "\n"; +printf "#define SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER \\\n%s\n", codelist(@protosv4); +printf "#define SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER \\\n%s\n", codelist(@protosv6); +print "\n"; + +sub collect { + my ($daemon, $ipv4, $ipv6) = @_; + my (@names, @help) = ((), ()); + for my $p (@protos) { + next if ($protodetail{$p}->{"daemon"} eq $daemon && $daemon ne "zebra"); + next unless (($ipv4 && $protodetail{$p}->{"ipv4"}) + || ($ipv6 && $protodetail{$p}->{"ipv6"})); + push @names, $protodetail{$p}->{"cname"}; + push @help, " \"".$protodetail{$p}->{"longhelp"}."\\n\""; + } + return ("\"(" . join("|", @names) . ")\"", join(" \\\n", @help)); +} + +for my $daemon (sort keys %daemons) { + next unless ($daemons{$daemon}->{"ipv4"} || $daemons{$daemon}->{"ipv6"}); + printf "/* %s */\n", $daemon; + if ($daemons{$daemon}->{"ipv4"} && $daemons{$daemon}->{"ipv6"}) { + my ($names, $help) = collect($daemon, 1, 1); + printf "#define QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_%s \\\n %s\n", uc $daemon, $names; + printf "#define QUAGGA_REDIST_HELP_STR_%s \\\n%s\n", uc $daemon, $help; + ($names, $help) = collect($daemon, 1, 0); + printf "#define QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_%s \\\n %s\n", uc $daemon, $names; + printf "#define QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_%s \\\n%s\n", uc $daemon, $help; + ($names, $help) = collect($daemon, 0, 1); + printf "#define QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_%s \\\n %s\n", uc $daemon, $names; + printf "#define QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_%s \\\n%s\n", uc $daemon, $help; + } else { + my ($names, $help) = collect($daemon, + $daemons{$daemon}->{"ipv4"}, $daemons{$daemon}->{"ipv6"}); + printf "#define QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_%s \\\n %s\n", uc $daemon, $names; + printf "#define QUAGGA_REDIST_HELP_STR_%s \\\n%s\n", uc $daemon, $help; + } + print "\n"; +} + +print <<EOF; + +#ifdef QUAGGA_DEFINE_DESC_TABLE + +struct zebra_desc_table +{ + unsigned int type; + const char *string; + char chr; +}; + +#define DESC_ENTRY(T,S,C) [(T)] = { (T), (S), (C) } +static const struct zebra_desc_table route_types[] = { +EOF + +for (my $c = 0; $c < @protos; $c++) { + my $p = $protos[$c]; + printf " DESC_ENTRY\t(%s\t \"%s\",\t'%s' ),\n", + $p.",", $protodetail{$p}->{"cname"}, $protodetail{$p}->{"char"}; +} + +print <<EOF; +}; +#undef DESC_ENTRY + +#endif /* QUAGGA_DEFINE_DESC_TABLE */ + +#endif /* _QUAGGA_ROUTE_TYPES_H */ +EOF + diff --git a/lib/route_types.txt b/lib/route_types.txt index e99cacde..8111fc56 100644 --- a/lib/route_types.txt +++ b/lib/route_types.txt @@ -42,13 +42,13 @@ ## type cname daemon C 4 6 short help ZEBRA_ROUTE_SYSTEM, system, NULL, 'X', 0, 0, "Reserved" -ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL, kernel, zebra, 'K', 1, 1, NULL -ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT, connected, zebra, 'C', 1, 1, NULL -ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC, static, zebra, 'S', 1, 1, NULL +ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL, kernel, zebra, 'K', 1, 1, "kernel route" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT, connected, zebra, 'C', 1, 1, "connected" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC, static, zebra, 'S', 1, 1, "static" ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP, rip, ripd, 'R', 1, 0, "RIP" ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG, ripng, ripngd, 'R', 0, 1, "RIPng" ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF, ospf, ospfd, 'O', 1, 0, "OSPF" -ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6, ospf6, ospf6d, 'O', 0, 1, "OSPF" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6, ospf6, ospf6d, 'O', 0, 1, "OSPFv6" ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS, isis, isisd, 'I', 1, 1, "IS-IS" ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP, bgp, bgpd, 'B', 1, 1, "BGP" # HSLS and OLSR both are AFI independent (so: 1, 1), however @@ -56,8 +56,10 @@ ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP, bgp, bgpd, 'B', 1, 1, "BGP" # This at least makes it trivial for users of these protocols # to 'switch on' redist support (direct numeric entry remaining # possible). -ZEBRA_ROUTE_HSLS, hsls, hslsd, 'H', 0, 0, "HSLS" -ZEBRA_ROUTE_OLSR, olsr, oslrd, 'o', 0, 0, "OLSR" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_HSLS, hsls, hslsd, 'h', 1, 1, "HSLS" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_OLSR, olsr, olsrd, 'o', 1, 1, "OLSR" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_BATMAN, batman, batman, 'b', 1, 1, "BATMAN" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_DHCP, dhcp, dhcpc, 'D', 1, 0, "DHCP" ## help strings ZEBRA_ROUTE_SYSTEM, "Reserved route type, for internal use only" @@ -72,3 +74,6 @@ ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS, "Intermediate System to Intermediate System (IS-IS)" ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP, "Border Gateway Protocol (BGP)" ZEBRA_ROUTE_HSLS, "Hazy-Sighted Link State Protocol (HSLS)" ZEBRA_ROUTE_OLSR, "Optimised Link State Routing (OLSR)" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_BATMAN, "Better Approach To Mobile Ad-hoc Networking (BATMAN)" +ZEBRA_ROUTE_DHCP, "Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)" + diff --git a/lib/sockunion.c b/lib/sockunion.c index 6a40f332..d1f6d80b 100644 --- a/lib/sockunion.c +++ b/lib/sockunion.c @@ -527,6 +527,30 @@ sockopt_ttl (int family, int sock, int ttl) return 0; } +int +sockopt_v6only (int family, int sock) +{ + int ret, on = 1; + +#ifdef HAVE_IPV6 +#ifdef IPV6_V6ONLY + if (family == AF_INET6) + { + ret = setsockopt (sock, IPPROTO_IPV6, IPV6_V6ONLY, + (void *) &on, sizeof (int)); + if (ret < 0) + { + zlog (NULL, LOG_WARNING, "can't set sockopt IPV6_V6ONLY " + "to socket %d", sock); + return -1; + } + return 0; + } +#endif /* IPV6_V6ONLY */ +#endif /* HAVE_IPV6 */ + return 0; +} + /* If same family and same prefix return 1. */ int sockunion_same (union sockunion *su1, union sockunion *su2) diff --git a/lib/sockunion.h b/lib/sockunion.h index 96b9a0d4..db145cf2 100644 --- a/lib/sockunion.h +++ b/lib/sockunion.h @@ -99,6 +99,7 @@ extern int sockunion_accept (int sock, union sockunion *); extern int sockunion_stream_socket (union sockunion *); extern int sockopt_reuseaddr (int); extern int sockopt_reuseport (int); +extern int sockopt_v6only (int family, int sock); extern int sockunion_bind (int sock, union sockunion *, unsigned short, union sockunion *); extern int sockopt_ttl (int family, int sock, int ttl); @@ -1816,6 +1816,7 @@ vty_serv_sock_addrinfo (const char *hostname, unsigned short port) if (sock < 0) continue; + sockopt_v6only (ainfo->ai_family, sock); sockopt_reuseaddr (sock); sockopt_reuseport (sock); diff --git a/lib/zclient.c b/lib/zclient.c index d3d53227..0d531ce7 100644 --- a/lib/zclient.c +++ b/lib/zclient.c @@ -32,6 +32,7 @@ #include "zclient.h" #include "memory.h" #include "table.h" +#include "paths.h" /* Zebra client events. */ enum event {ZCLIENT_SCHEDULE, ZCLIENT_READ, ZCLIENT_CONNECT}; @@ -317,7 +318,7 @@ zclient_start (struct zclient *zclient) #ifdef HAVE_TCP_ZEBRA zclient->sock = zclient_socket (); #else - zclient->sock = zclient_socket_un (ZEBRA_SERV_PATH); + zclient->sock = zclient_socket_un (path_state (ZEBRA_SERV_NAME)); #endif /* HAVE_TCP_ZEBRA */ if (zclient->sock < 0) { diff --git a/lib/zclient.h b/lib/zclient.h index 21786ab8..6a63ffa4 100644 --- a/lib/zclient.h +++ b/lib/zclient.h @@ -28,6 +28,9 @@ /* For input/output buffer to zebra. */ #define ZEBRA_MAX_PACKET_SIZ 4096 +/* Name of the zebra API socket */ +#define ZEBRA_SERV_NAME "zserv.api" + /* Zebra header size. */ #define ZEBRA_HEADER_SIZE 6 diff --git a/lib/zebra.h b/lib/zebra.h index 2dc84514..b580934c 100644 --- a/lib/zebra.h +++ b/lib/zebra.h @@ -429,19 +429,8 @@ struct in_pktinfo */ #define ZEBRA_HEADER_MARKER 255 -/* Zebra route's types. */ -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_SYSTEM 0 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL 1 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT 2 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC 3 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP 4 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG 5 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF 6 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6 7 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS 8 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP 9 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_HSLS 10 -#define ZEBRA_ROUTE_MAX 11 +/* Zebra route's types are defined in route_types.h */ +#include "route_types.h" /* Note: whenever a new route-type or zserv-command is added the * corresponding {command,route}_types[] table in lib/log.c MUST be @@ -455,6 +444,10 @@ extern char zebra_route_char(unsigned int route_type); * e.g. ZEBRA_INTERFACE_ADD -> "ZEBRA_INTERFACE_ADD" */ /* Map a protocol name to its number. e.g. ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP->9*/ extern int proto_name2num(const char *s); +/* Map redistribute X argument to protocol number. + * unlike proto_name2num, this accepts shorthands and takes + * an AFI value to restrict input */ +extern int proto_redistnum(int afi, const char *s); extern const char *zserv_command_string (unsigned int command); diff --git a/m4/.gitignore b/m4/.gitignore index 3f3bd0a7..69a70a54 100644 --- a/m4/.gitignore +++ b/m4/.gitignore @@ -4,4 +4,5 @@ Makefile.in .arch-ids *~ *.loT +*.m4 diff --git a/mkinstalldirs b/mkinstalldirs deleted file mode 100755 index 86e2b5ed..00000000 --- a/mkinstalldirs +++ /dev/null @@ -1,101 +0,0 @@ -#! /bin/sh -# mkinstalldirs --- make directory hierarchy -# Author: Noah Friedman <friedman@prep.ai.mit.edu> -# Created: 1993-05-16 -# Public domain - -# $Id: mkinstalldirs,v 1.2 2003/02/17 23:54:05 paul Exp $ - -errstatus=0 -dirmode="" - -usage="\ -Usage: mkinstalldirs [-h] [--help] [-m mode] dir ..." - -# process command line arguments -while test $# -gt 0 ; do - case "${1}" in - -h | --help | --h* ) # -h for help - echo "${usage}" 1>&2; exit 0 ;; - -m ) # -m PERM arg - shift - test $# -eq 0 && { echo "${usage}" 1>&2; exit 1; } - dirmode="${1}" - shift ;; - -- ) shift; break ;; # stop option processing - -* ) echo "${usage}" 1>&2; exit 1 ;; # unknown option - * ) break ;; # first non-opt arg - esac -done - -for file -do - if test -d "$file"; then - shift - else - break - fi -done - -case $# in -0) exit 0 ;; -esac - -case $dirmode in -'') - if mkdir -p -- . 2>/dev/null; then - echo "mkdir -p -- $*" - exec mkdir -p -- "$@" - fi ;; -*) - if mkdir -m "$dirmode" -p -- . 2>/dev/null; then - echo "mkdir -m $dirmode -p -- $*" - exec mkdir -m "$dirmode" -p -- "$@" - fi ;; -esac - -for file -do - set fnord `echo ":$file" | sed -ne 's/^:\//#/;s/^://;s/\// /g;s/^#/\//;p'` - shift - - pathcomp= - for d - do - pathcomp="$pathcomp$d" - case "$pathcomp" in - -* ) pathcomp=./$pathcomp ;; - esac - - if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then - echo "mkdir $pathcomp" - - mkdir "$pathcomp" || lasterr=$? - - if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then - errstatus=$lasterr - else - if test ! -z "$dirmode"; then - echo "chmod $dirmode $pathcomp" - - lasterr="" - chmod "$dirmode" "$pathcomp" || lasterr=$? - - if test ! -z "$lasterr"; then - errstatus=$lasterr - fi - fi - fi - fi - - pathcomp="$pathcomp/" - done -done - -exit $errstatus - -# Local Variables: -# mode: shell-script -# sh-indentation: 3 -# End: -# mkinstalldirs ends here diff --git a/ospf6d/Makefile.am b/ospf6d/Makefile.am index 01bc6fe0..eeed1652 100644 --- a/ospf6d/Makefile.am +++ b/ospf6d/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,6 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 AM_CFLAGS = $(PICFLAGS) diff --git a/ospf6d/ospf6_asbr.c b/ospf6d/ospf6_asbr.c index 685b147c..d6c1517e 100644 --- a/ospf6d/ospf6_asbr.c +++ b/ospf6d/ospf6_asbr.c @@ -616,27 +616,16 @@ ospf6_asbr_redistribute_remove (int type, int ifindex, struct prefix *prefix) DEFUN (ospf6_redistribute, ospf6_redistribute_cmd, - "redistribute (static|kernel|connected|ripng|bgp)", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_OSPF6D, "Redistribute\n" - "Static route\n" - "Kernel route\n" - "Connected route\n" - "RIPng route\n" - "BGP route\n" + QUAGGA_REDIST_HELP_STR_OSPF6D ) { - int type = 0; - - if (strncmp (argv[0], "sta", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "ker", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "con", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "rip", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "bgp", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; + int type; + + type = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6) + return CMD_WARNING; ospf6_asbr_redistribute_unset (type); ospf6_asbr_routemap_unset (type); @@ -646,29 +635,18 @@ DEFUN (ospf6_redistribute, DEFUN (ospf6_redistribute_routemap, ospf6_redistribute_routemap_cmd, - "redistribute (static|kernel|connected|ripng|bgp) route-map WORD", + "redistribute " QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_OSPF6D " route-map WORD", "Redistribute\n" - "Static routes\n" - "Kernel route\n" - "Connected route\n" - "RIPng route\n" - "BGP route\n" + QUAGGA_REDIST_HELP_STR_OSPF6D "Route map reference\n" "Route map name\n" ) { - int type = 0; - - if (strncmp (argv[0], "sta", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "ker", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "con", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "rip", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "bgp", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; + int type; + + type = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6) + return CMD_WARNING; ospf6_asbr_redistribute_unset (type); ospf6_asbr_routemap_set (type, argv[1]); @@ -678,28 +656,17 @@ DEFUN (ospf6_redistribute_routemap, DEFUN (no_ospf6_redistribute, no_ospf6_redistribute_cmd, - "no redistribute (static|kernel|connected|ripng|bgp)", + "no redistribute " QUAGGA_REDIST_STR_OSPF6D, NO_STR "Redistribute\n" - "Static route\n" - "Kernel route\n" - "Connected route\n" - "RIPng route\n" - "BGP route\n" + QUAGGA_REDIST_HELP_STR_OSPF6D ) { - int type = 0; - - if (strncmp (argv[0], "sta", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "ker", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "con", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "rip", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "bgp", 3) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; + int type; + + type = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0 || type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6) + return CMD_WARNING; ospf6_asbr_redistribute_unset (type); ospf6_asbr_routemap_unset (type); diff --git a/ospf6d/ospf6_main.c b/ospf6d/ospf6_main.c index a7a96a1f..c33fe9f2 100644 --- a/ospf6d/ospf6_main.c +++ b/ospf6d/ospf6_main.c @@ -34,11 +34,14 @@ #include "plist.h" #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "ospf6d.h" /* Default configuration file name for ospf6d. */ -#define OSPF6_DEFAULT_CONFIG "ospf6d.conf" +#define OSPF6_CONFIG_NAME "ospf6d.conf" +#define OSPF6_PID_NAME "ospf6d.pid" +#define OSPF6_VTY_NAME "ospf6d.vty" /* Default port values. */ #define OSPF6_VTY_PORT 2606 @@ -70,6 +73,7 @@ struct zebra_privs_t ospf6d_privs = struct option longopts[] = { { "daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, { "pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, { "vty_addr", required_argument, NULL, 'A'}, @@ -83,7 +87,7 @@ struct option longopts[] = }; /* Configuration file and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR OSPF6_DEFAULT_CONFIG; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; /* ospf6d program name. */ char *progname; @@ -94,8 +98,11 @@ int daemon_mode = 0; /* Master of threads. */ struct thread_master *master; +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_OSPF6D_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* Help information display. */ static void @@ -108,6 +115,7 @@ usage (char *progname, int status) printf ("Usage : %s [OPTION...]\n\n\ Daemon which manages OSPF version 3.\n\n\ -d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n\ +-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n\ -f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n\ -i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n\ -A, --vty_addr Set vty's bind address\n\ @@ -197,7 +205,7 @@ main (int argc, char *argv[], char *envp[]) /* Command line argument treatment. */ while (1) { - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "df:i:hp:A:P:u:g:vC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "dN:f:i:hp:A:P:u:g:vC", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -209,6 +217,9 @@ main (int argc, char *argv[], char *envp[]) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'f': config_file = optarg; break; @@ -252,6 +263,9 @@ main (int argc, char *argv[], char *envp[]) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (OSPF6_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (OSPF6_PID_NAME)); + /* thread master */ master = thread_master_create (); @@ -294,7 +308,7 @@ main (int argc, char *argv[], char *envp[]) /* Make ospf6 vty socket. */ if (!vty_port) vty_port = OSPF6_VTY_PORT; - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, OSPF6_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (OSPF6_VTY_NAME)); /* Print start message */ zlog_notice ("OSPF6d (Quagga-%s ospf6d-%s) starts: vty@%d", diff --git a/ospfd/Makefile.am b/ospfd/Makefile.am index 2e4d5c8e..bed90d7b 100644 --- a/ospfd/Makefile.am +++ b/ospfd/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ $(LOCAL_OPTS) -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" +DEFS = @DEFS@ $(LOCAL_OPTS) INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 lib_LTLIBRARIES = libospf.la diff --git a/ospfd/ospf_main.c b/ospfd/ospf_main.c index 8b9a3458..0e9e182a 100644 --- a/ospfd/ospf_main.c +++ b/ospfd/ospf_main.c @@ -38,6 +38,7 @@ #include "memory.h" #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "ospfd/ospfd.h" #include "ospfd/ospf_interface.h" @@ -72,12 +73,13 @@ struct zebra_privs_t ospfd_privs = }; /* Configuration filename and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR OSPF_DEFAULT_CONFIG; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; /* OSPFd options. */ struct option longopts[] = { { "daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, { "pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, { "dryrun", no_argument, NULL, 'C'}, @@ -96,8 +98,11 @@ struct option longopts[] = /* Master of threads. */ struct thread_master *master; +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_OSPFD_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; #ifdef SUPPORT_OSPF_API extern int ospf_apiserver_enable; @@ -114,6 +119,7 @@ usage (char *progname, int status) printf ("Usage : %s [OPTION...]\n\ Daemon which manages OSPF.\n\n\ -d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n\ +-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n\ -f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n\ -i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n\ -A, --vty_addr Set vty's bind address\n\ @@ -214,7 +220,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) { int opt; - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "df:i:hA:P:u:g:avC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "dN:f:i:hA:P:u:g:avC", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -226,6 +232,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'f': config_file = optarg; break; @@ -274,6 +283,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (OSPF_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (OSPF_PID_NAME)); + /* Initializations. */ master = om->master; @@ -324,7 +336,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) pid_output (pid_file); /* Create VTY socket */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, OSPF_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (OSPF_VTY_NAME)); /* Print banner. */ zlog_notice ("OSPFd %s starting: vty@%d", QUAGGA_VERSION, vty_port); diff --git a/ospfd/ospf_vty.c b/ospfd/ospf_vty.c index adc822a7..d024a2ac 100644 --- a/ospfd/ospf_vty.c +++ b/ospfd/ospf_vty.c @@ -93,29 +93,6 @@ ospf_str2area_id (const char *str, struct in_addr *area_id, int *format) static int -str2distribute_source (const char *str, int *source) -{ - /* Sanity check. */ - if (str == NULL) - return 0; - - if (strncmp (str, "k", 1) == 0) - *source = ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (str, "c", 1) == 0) - *source = ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (str, "s", 1) == 0) - *source = ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else if (strncmp (str, "r", 1) == 0) - *source = ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP; - else if (strncmp (str, "b", 1) == 0) - *source = ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; - else - return 0; - - return 1; -} - -static int str2metric (const char *str, int *metric) { /* Sanity check. */ @@ -5818,7 +5795,8 @@ DEFUN (ospf_redistribute_source_metric_type, int metric = -1; /* Get distribute source. */ - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[0], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; /* Get metric value. */ @@ -5879,7 +5857,8 @@ DEFUN (ospf_redistribute_source_type_metric, int metric = -1; /* Get distribute source. */ - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[0], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; /* Get metric value. */ @@ -5943,7 +5922,8 @@ DEFUN (ospf_redistribute_source_metric_routemap, int metric = -1; /* Get distribute source. */ - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[0], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; /* Get metric value. */ @@ -5976,7 +5956,8 @@ DEFUN (ospf_redistribute_source_type_routemap, int type = -1; /* Get distribute source. */ - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[0], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; /* Get metric value. */ @@ -6004,7 +5985,8 @@ DEFUN (ospf_redistribute_source_routemap, int source; /* Get distribute source. */ - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[0], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; if (argc == 2) @@ -6025,7 +6007,8 @@ DEFUN (no_ospf_redistribute_source, struct ospf *ospf = vty->index; int source; - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[0], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; ospf_routemap_unset (ospf, source); @@ -6044,7 +6027,8 @@ DEFUN (ospf_distribute_list_out, int source; /* Get distribute source. */ - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[1], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; return ospf_distribute_list_out_set (ospf, source, argv[0]); @@ -6062,7 +6046,8 @@ DEFUN (no_ospf_distribute_list_out, struct ospf *ospf = vty->index; int source; - if (!str2distribute_source (argv[1], &source)) + source = proto_redistnum(AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (source < 0 || source == ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF) return CMD_WARNING; return ospf_distribute_list_out_unset (ospf, source, argv[0]); diff --git a/ospfd/ospfd.h b/ospfd/ospfd.h index b24b3ced..64e91cef 100644 --- a/ospfd/ospfd.h +++ b/ospfd/ospfd.h @@ -48,7 +48,9 @@ #define OSPF_VL_IP_TTL 100 /* Default configuration file name for ospfd. */ -#define OSPF_DEFAULT_CONFIG "ospfd.conf" +#define OSPF_CONFIG_NAME "ospfd.conf" +#define OSPF_PID_NAME "ospfd.pid" +#define OSPF_VTY_NAME "ospfd.vty" /* Architectual Constants */ #ifdef DEBUG diff --git a/ripd/Makefile.am b/ripd/Makefile.am index 2fa26659..a6d3d398 100644 --- a/ripd/Makefile.am +++ b/ripd/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,6 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 AM_CFLAGS = $(PICFLAGS) diff --git a/ripd/rip_main.c b/ripd/rip_main.c index 57b5f3af..72348a04 100644 --- a/ripd/rip_main.c +++ b/ripd/rip_main.c @@ -32,6 +32,7 @@ #include "log.h" #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "ripd/ripd.h" @@ -39,6 +40,7 @@ static struct option longopts[] = { { "daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, { "pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, { "help", no_argument, NULL, 'h'}, @@ -76,7 +78,7 @@ struct zebra_privs_t ripd_privs = }; /* Configuration file and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR RIPD_DEFAULT_CONFIG; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; char *config_file = NULL; /* ripd program name */ @@ -93,8 +95,11 @@ int vty_port = RIP_VTY_PORT; /* Master of threads. */ struct thread_master *master; +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_RIPD_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* Help information display. */ static void @@ -107,6 +112,7 @@ usage (char *progname, int status) printf ("Usage : %s [OPTION...]\n\ Daemon which manages RIP version 1 and 2.\n\n\ -d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n\ +-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n\ -f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n\ -i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n\ -A, --vty_addr Set vty's bind address\n\ @@ -137,7 +143,7 @@ sighup (void) vty_read_config (config_file, config_default); /* Create VTY's socket */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, RIP_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (RIPD_VTY_NAME)); /* Try to return to normal operation. */ } @@ -206,7 +212,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) { int opt; - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "df:i:hA:P:u:g:rvC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "dN:f:i:hA:P:u:g:rvC", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -218,6 +224,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'f': config_file = optarg; break; @@ -264,6 +273,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (RIPD_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (RIPD_PID_NAME)); + /* Prepare master thread. */ master = thread_master_create (); @@ -302,7 +314,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) pid_output (pid_file); /* Create VTY's socket */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, RIP_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (RIPD_VTY_NAME)); /* Print banner. */ zlog_notice ("RIPd %s starting: vty@%d", QUAGGA_VERSION, vty_port); diff --git a/ripd/ripd.h b/ripd/ripd.h index 45b07b9c..01ca562e 100644 --- a/ripd/ripd.h +++ b/ripd/ripd.h @@ -69,7 +69,9 @@ #define RIP_VTY_PORT 2602 /* Default configuration file name. */ -#define RIPD_DEFAULT_CONFIG "ripd.conf" +#define RIPD_CONFIG_NAME "ripd.conf" +#define RIPD_PID_NAME "ripd.pid" +#define RIPD_VTY_NAME "ripd.vty" /* RIP route types. */ #define RIP_ROUTE_RTE 0 diff --git a/ripngd/Makefile.am b/ripngd/Makefile.am index c6bd4868..ba52dba7 100644 --- a/ripngd/Makefile.am +++ b/ripngd/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,6 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 AM_CFLAGS = $(PICFLAGS) diff --git a/ripngd/ripng_main.c b/ripngd/ripng_main.c index 85209a15..62477b6f 100644 --- a/ripngd/ripng_main.c +++ b/ripngd/ripng_main.c @@ -34,17 +34,19 @@ #include "if.h" #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "ripngd/ripngd.h" /* Configuration filename and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR RIPNG_DEFAULT_CONFIG; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; char *config_file = NULL; /* RIPngd options. */ struct option longopts[] = { { "daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, { "pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, { "dryrun", no_argument, NULL, 'C'}, @@ -96,8 +98,11 @@ int vty_port = RIPNG_VTY_PORT; /* Master of threads. */ struct thread_master *master; +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_RIPNGD_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* Help information display. */ static void @@ -110,6 +115,7 @@ usage (char *progname, int status) printf ("Usage : %s [OPTION...]\n\ Daemon which manages RIPng.\n\n\ -d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n\ +-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n\ -f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n\ -i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n\ -A, --vty_addr Set vty's bind address\n\ @@ -137,7 +143,7 @@ sighup (void) /* Reload config file. */ vty_read_config (config_file, config_default); /* Create VTY's socket */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, RIPNG_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (RIPNG_VTY_NAME)); /* Try to return to normal operation. */ } @@ -205,7 +211,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) { int opt; - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "df:i:hA:P:u:g:vC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "dN:f:i:hA:P:u:g:vC", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -217,6 +223,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'f': config_file = optarg; break; @@ -263,6 +272,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (RIPNG_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (RIPNG_PID_NAME)); + master = thread_master_create (); /* Library inits. */ @@ -295,7 +307,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) } /* Create VTY socket */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, RIPNG_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (RIPNG_VTY_NAME)); /* Process id file create. */ pid_output (pid_file); diff --git a/ripngd/ripngd.h b/ripngd/ripngd.h index ab06d81b..71615c3c 100644 --- a/ripngd/ripngd.h +++ b/ripngd/ripngd.h @@ -51,7 +51,9 @@ #define RIPNG_PEER_TIMER_DEFAULT 180 /* Default config file name. */ -#define RIPNG_DEFAULT_CONFIG "ripngd.conf" +#define RIPNG_CONFIG_NAME "ripngd.conf" +#define RIPNG_PID_NAME "ripngd.pid" +#define RIPNG_VTY_NAME "ripngd.vty" /* RIPng route types. */ #define RIPNG_ROUTE_RTE 0 diff --git a/vtysh/Makefile.am b/vtysh/Makefile.am index 791d95dd..59265060 100644 --- a/vtysh/Makefile.am +++ b/vtysh/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,6 @@ ## Process this file with Automake to create Makefile.in INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" LIBS = @LIBS@ @CURSES@ @LIBPAM@ diff --git a/vtysh/vtysh.c b/vtysh/vtysh.c index 3f189adb..8df8dc17 100644 --- a/vtysh/vtysh.c +++ b/vtysh/vtysh.c @@ -34,6 +34,7 @@ #include "memory.h" #include "vtysh/vtysh.h" #include "log.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "bgpd/bgp_vty.h" /* Struct VTY. */ @@ -48,16 +49,15 @@ struct vtysh_client int fd; const char *name; int flag; - const char *path; } vtysh_client[] = { - { .fd = -1, .name = "zebra", .flag = VTYSH_ZEBRA, .path = ZEBRA_VTYSH_PATH}, - { .fd = -1, .name = "ripd", .flag = VTYSH_RIPD, .path = RIP_VTYSH_PATH}, - { .fd = -1, .name = "ripngd", .flag = VTYSH_RIPNGD, .path = RIPNG_VTYSH_PATH}, - { .fd = -1, .name = "ospfd", .flag = VTYSH_OSPFD, .path = OSPF_VTYSH_PATH}, - { .fd = -1, .name = "ospf6d", .flag = VTYSH_OSPF6D, .path = OSPF6_VTYSH_PATH}, - { .fd = -1, .name = "bgpd", .flag = VTYSH_BGPD, .path = BGP_VTYSH_PATH}, - { .fd = -1, .name = "isisd", .flag = VTYSH_ISISD, .path = ISIS_VTYSH_PATH}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "zebra", .flag = VTYSH_ZEBRA}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "ripd", .flag = VTYSH_RIPD}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "ripngd", .flag = VTYSH_RIPNGD}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "ospfd", .flag = VTYSH_OSPFD}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "ospf6d", .flag = VTYSH_OSPF6D}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "bgpd", .flag = VTYSH_BGPD}, + { .fd = -1, .name = "isisd", .flag = VTYSH_ISISD}, }; #define VTYSH_INDEX_MAX (sizeof(vtysh_client)/sizeof(vtysh_client[0])) @@ -2103,13 +2103,17 @@ vtysh_connect (struct vtysh_client *vclient) int sock, len; struct sockaddr_un addr; struct stat s_stat; + char path[MAXPATHLEN]; + + /* figure out path to daemon VTY socket */ + snprintf (path, sizeof(path), "%s.vty", path_state (vclient->name)); /* Stat socket to see if we have permission to access it. */ - ret = stat (vclient->path, &s_stat); + ret = stat (path, &s_stat); if (ret < 0 && errno != ENOENT) { fprintf (stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): stat = %s\n", - vclient->path, safe_strerror(errno)); + path, safe_strerror(errno)); exit(1); } @@ -2117,8 +2121,7 @@ vtysh_connect (struct vtysh_client *vclient) { if (! S_ISSOCK(s_stat.st_mode)) { - fprintf (stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): Not a socket\n", - vclient->path); + fprintf (stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): Not a socket\n", path); exit (1); } @@ -2128,7 +2131,7 @@ vtysh_connect (struct vtysh_client *vclient) if (sock < 0) { #ifdef DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): socket = %s\n", vclient->path, + fprintf(stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): socket = %s\n", path, safe_strerror(errno)); #endif /* DEBUG */ return -1; @@ -2136,7 +2139,7 @@ vtysh_connect (struct vtysh_client *vclient) memset (&addr, 0, sizeof (struct sockaddr_un)); addr.sun_family = AF_UNIX; - strncpy (addr.sun_path, vclient->path, strlen (vclient->path)); + strncpy (addr.sun_path, path, sizeof (addr.sun_path)); #ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_SOCKADDR_UN_SUN_LEN len = addr.sun_len = SUN_LEN(&addr); #else @@ -2147,7 +2150,7 @@ vtysh_connect (struct vtysh_client *vclient) if (ret < 0) { #ifdef DEBUG - fprintf(stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): connect = %s\n", vclient->path, + fprintf(stderr, "vtysh_connect(%s): connect = %s\n", path, safe_strerror(errno)); #endif /* DEBUG */ close (sock); diff --git a/vtysh/vtysh_main.c b/vtysh/vtysh_main.c index 4a315a5c..bdff22de 100644 --- a/vtysh/vtysh_main.c +++ b/vtysh/vtysh_main.c @@ -33,6 +33,7 @@ #include "getopt.h" #include "command.h" #include "memory.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "vtysh/vtysh.h" #include "vtysh/vtysh_user.h" @@ -41,7 +42,6 @@ char *progname; /* Configuration file name and directory. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR VTYSH_DEFAULT_CONFIG; char history_file[MAXPATHLEN]; /* Flag for indicate executing child command. */ @@ -143,6 +143,7 @@ usage (int status) "-d, --daemon Connect only to the specified daemon\n" \ "-E, --echo Echo prompt and command in -c mode\n" \ "-C, --dryrun Check configuration for validity and exit\n" \ + "-N, --namespace Use prefixed daemon socket names\n" \ "-h, --help Display this help and exit\n\n" \ "Note that multiple commands may be executed from the command\n" \ "line by passing multiple -c args, or by embedding linefeed\n" \ @@ -162,6 +163,7 @@ struct option longopts[] = { "daemon", required_argument, NULL, 'd'}, { "echo", no_argument, NULL, 'E'}, { "dryrun", no_argument, NULL, 'C'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "help", no_argument, NULL, 'h'}, { "noerror", no_argument, NULL, 'n'}, { 0 } @@ -237,7 +239,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **env) /* Option handling. */ while (1) { - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "be:c:d:nEhC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "be:c:d:nEhCN:", longopts, 0); if (opt == EOF) break; @@ -278,6 +280,20 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **env) case 'h': usage (0); break; + case 'N': + /* we're using this as a path component, so... + * for the daemons we can assume no malicious tampering + * with the cmdline, but for vtysh we have to check + */ + if (strchr (optarg, '/') || optarg[0] == '.') + { + fprintf (stderr, "The namespace argument may not include " + "slashes or start with a dot.\n"); + break; + } + + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; default: usage (1); break; @@ -302,7 +318,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv, char **env) sort_node (); /* Read vtysh configuration file before connecting to daemons. */ - vtysh_read_config (config_default); + vtysh_read_config (path_config (VTYSH_DEFAULT_CONFIG)); /* Start execution only if not in dry-run mode */ if(dryrun) diff --git a/zebra/Makefile.am b/zebra/Makefile.am index 542f36f4..828e88ff 100644 --- a/zebra/Makefile.am +++ b/zebra/Makefile.am @@ -1,7 +1,7 @@ ## Process this file with automake to produce Makefile.in. INCLUDES = @INCLUDES@ -I.. -I$(top_srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/lib @SNMP_INCLUDES@ -DEFS = @DEFS@ -DSYSCONFDIR=\"$(sysconfdir)/\" -DMULTIPATH_NUM=@MULTIPATH_NUM@ +DEFS = @DEFS@ -DMULTIPATH_NUM=@MULTIPATH_NUM@ INSTALL_SDATA=@INSTALL@ -m 600 LIB_IPV6 = @LIB_IPV6@ diff --git a/zebra/connected.c b/zebra/connected.c index 95399fa1..0c22582d 100644 --- a/zebra/connected.c +++ b/zebra/connected.c @@ -36,6 +36,53 @@ #include "zebra/interface.h" #include "zebra/connected.h" extern struct zebra_t zebrad; + +#ifdef HAVE_NETLINK +static const struct message rtscope_str[] = { + {RT_SCOPE_UNIVERSE, "global"}, + {RT_SCOPE_SITE, "site"}, + {RT_SCOPE_LINK, "link"}, + {RT_SCOPE_HOST, "host"}, + {RT_SCOPE_NOWHERE, "nowhere"}, + {0, NULL} +}; + +/* for use in show interface */ +const char * +connected_scope_name(unsigned value) +{ + const char *str; + static char buf[16]; + + str = lookup (rtscope_str, value); + if (!str || !*str) { + snprintf (buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", value); + str = buf; + } + return str; +} + +int +connected_scope_number(const char *name) +{ + const struct message *m; + char *errptr; + unsigned value; + + if (!name || !*name) + return -1; + + for (m = rtscope_str; m->str; m++) + if (!strcmp (m->str, name)) + return m->key; + + value = strtoul (name, &errptr, 0); + if (*errptr || value > 255) + return -1; + + return value; +} +#endif /* HAVE_NETLINK */ /* withdraw a connected address */ static void @@ -112,6 +159,30 @@ connected_check (struct interface *ifp, struct prefix *p) return NULL; } +/* same, but with peer address */ +struct connected * +connected_check_ptp (struct interface *ifp, struct prefix *p, struct prefix *d) +{ + struct connected *ifc; + struct listnode *node; + + /* ignore broadcast addresses */ + if (p->prefixlen != IPV4_MAX_PREFIXLEN) + d = NULL; + + for (ALL_LIST_ELEMENTS_RO (ifp->connected, node, ifc)) + { + if (!prefix_same (ifc->address, p)) + continue; + if (!CONNECTED_PEER(ifc) && !d) + return ifc; + if (CONNECTED_PEER(ifc) && d && prefix_same (ifc->destination, d)) + return ifc; + } + + return NULL; +} + /* Check if two ifc's describe the same address */ static int connected_same (struct connected *ifc1, struct connected *ifc2) @@ -148,7 +219,7 @@ connected_implicit_withdraw (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) struct connected *current; /* Check same connected route. */ - if ((current = connected_check (ifp, (struct prefix *) ifc->address))) + if ((current = connected_check_ptp (ifp, ifc->address, ifc->destination))) { if (CHECK_FLAG(current->conf, ZEBRA_IFC_CONFIGURED)) SET_FLAG(ifc->conf, ZEBRA_IFC_CONFIGURED); @@ -198,7 +269,7 @@ connected_up_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) void connected_add_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in_addr *addr, u_char prefixlen, struct in_addr *broad, - const char *label) + const char *label, unsigned scope, int preference) { struct prefix_ipv4 *p; struct connected *ifc; @@ -212,7 +283,8 @@ connected_add_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in_addr *addr, p = prefix_ipv4_new (); p->family = AF_INET; p->prefix = *addr; - p->prefixlen = prefixlen; + p->prefixlen = CHECK_FLAG(flags, ZEBRA_IFA_PEER) + ? IPV4_MAX_PREFIXLEN : prefixlen; ifc->address = (struct prefix *) p; /* If there is broadcast or peer address. */ @@ -269,6 +341,9 @@ connected_add_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in_addr *addr, if (label) ifc->label = XSTRDUP (MTYPE_CONNECTED_LABEL, label); + ifc->scope = scope; + ifc->preference = preference; + /* nothing to do? */ if ((ifc = connected_implicit_withdraw (ifp, ifc)) == NULL) return; @@ -305,15 +380,27 @@ void connected_delete_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in_addr *addr, u_char prefixlen, struct in_addr *broad) { - struct prefix_ipv4 p; + struct prefix_ipv4 p, d; struct connected *ifc; memset (&p, 0, sizeof (struct prefix_ipv4)); p.family = AF_INET; p.prefix = *addr; - p.prefixlen = prefixlen; + p.prefixlen = CHECK_FLAG(flags, ZEBRA_IFA_PEER) + ? IPV4_MAX_PREFIXLEN : prefixlen; + + if (broad) + { + memset (&d, 0, sizeof (struct prefix_ipv4)); + d.family = AF_INET; + d.prefix = *broad; + d.prefixlen = prefixlen; + ifc = connected_check_ptp (ifp, (struct prefix *) &p, + (struct prefix *) &d); + } + else + ifc = connected_check_ptp (ifp, (struct prefix *) &p, NULL); - ifc = connected_check (ifp, (struct prefix *) &p); if (! ifc) return; @@ -352,7 +439,7 @@ connected_up_ipv6 (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) void connected_add_ipv6 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in6_addr *addr, u_char prefixlen, struct in6_addr *broad, - const char *label) + const char *label, unsigned scope) { struct prefix_ipv6 *p; struct connected *ifc; @@ -395,7 +482,9 @@ connected_add_ipv6 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in6_addr *addr, /* Label of this address. */ if (label) ifc->label = XSTRDUP (MTYPE_CONNECTED_LABEL, label); - + + ifc->scope = scope; + if ((ifc = connected_implicit_withdraw (ifp, ifc)) == NULL) return; diff --git a/zebra/connected.h b/zebra/connected.h index 9595ddb1..ede75120 100644 --- a/zebra/connected.h +++ b/zebra/connected.h @@ -25,11 +25,13 @@ extern struct connected * connected_check (struct interface *ifp, struct prefix *p); +extern struct connected * +connected_check_ptp (struct interface *ifp, struct prefix *p, struct prefix *d); extern void connected_add_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in_addr *addr, u_char prefixlen, struct in_addr *broad, - const char *label); + const char *label, unsigned scope, int preference); extern void connected_delete_ipv4 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in_addr *addr, @@ -42,7 +44,7 @@ extern void connected_down_ipv4 (struct interface *, struct connected *); extern void connected_add_ipv6 (struct interface *ifp, int flags, struct in6_addr *address, u_char prefixlen, struct in6_addr *broad, - const char *label); + const char *label, unsigned scope); extern void connected_delete_ipv6 (struct interface *ifp, struct in6_addr *address, u_char prefixlen, struct in6_addr *broad); @@ -52,4 +54,9 @@ extern void connected_down_ipv6 (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *); #endif /* HAVE_IPV6 */ +#ifdef HAVE_NETLINK +extern const char *connected_scope_name (unsigned value); +extern int connected_scope_number (const char *name); +#endif /* HAVE_NETLINK */ + #endif /*_ZEBRA_CONNECTED_H */ diff --git a/zebra/if_ioctl.c b/zebra/if_ioctl.c index f357e154..36732704 100644 --- a/zebra/if_ioctl.c +++ b/zebra/if_ioctl.c @@ -276,7 +276,7 @@ if_getaddrs (void) } connected_add_ipv4 (ifp, flags, &addr->sin_addr, - prefixlen, dest_pnt, NULL); + prefixlen, dest_pnt, NULL, 0, 0); } #ifdef HAVE_IPV6 if (ifap->ifa_addr->sa_family == AF_INET6) @@ -321,7 +321,7 @@ if_getaddrs (void) #endif connected_add_ipv6 (ifp, flags, &addr->sin6_addr, prefixlen, - dest_pnt, NULL); + dest_pnt, NULL, 0); } #endif /* HAVE_IPV6 */ } @@ -412,7 +412,7 @@ if_get_addr (struct interface *ifp) /* Set address to the interface. */ - connected_add_ipv4 (ifp, flags, &addr.sin_addr, prefixlen, dest_pnt, NULL); + connected_add_ipv4 (ifp, flags, &addr.sin_addr, prefixlen, dest_pnt, NULL, 0, 0); return 0; } diff --git a/zebra/if_ioctl_solaris.c b/zebra/if_ioctl_solaris.c index fc384ea2..736232e8 100644 --- a/zebra/if_ioctl_solaris.c +++ b/zebra/if_ioctl_solaris.c @@ -327,11 +327,11 @@ if_get_addr (struct interface *ifp, struct sockaddr *addr, const char *label) /* Set address to the interface. */ if (af == AF_INET) connected_add_ipv4 (ifp, flags, &SIN (addr)->sin_addr, prefixlen, - (struct in_addr *) dest_pnt, label); + (struct in_addr *) dest_pnt, label, 0, 0); #ifdef HAVE_IPV6 else if (af == AF_INET6) connected_add_ipv6 (ifp, flags, &SIN6 (addr)->sin6_addr, prefixlen, - (struct in6_addr *) dest_pnt, label); + (struct in6_addr *) dest_pnt, label, 0); #endif /* HAVE_IPV6 */ return 0; diff --git a/zebra/if_proc.c b/zebra/if_proc.c index 3aec530b..6c538116 100644 --- a/zebra/if_proc.c +++ b/zebra/if_proc.c @@ -240,7 +240,7 @@ ifaddr_proc_ipv6 () str2in6_addr (addr, &p.prefix); p.prefixlen = plen; - connected_add_ipv6 (ifp, 0, &p.prefix, p.prefixlen, NULL, ifname); + connected_add_ipv6 (ifp, 0, &p.prefix, p.prefixlen, NULL, ifname, 0); } fclose (fp); return 0; diff --git a/zebra/interface.c b/zebra/interface.c index ba4cf25f..e09ca41f 100644 --- a/zebra/interface.c +++ b/zebra/interface.c @@ -127,7 +127,7 @@ if_subnet_add (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) /* Get address derived subnet node and associated address list, while marking address secondary attribute appropriately. */ - cp = *ifc->address; + cp = *CONNECTED_PREFIX(ifc); apply_mask (&cp); rn = route_node_get (zebra_if->ipv4_subnets, &cp); @@ -154,12 +154,16 @@ if_subnet_delete (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) struct route_node *rn; struct zebra_if *zebra_if; struct list *addr_list; + struct prefix cp; assert (ifp && ifp->info && ifc); zebra_if = ifp->info; + cp = *CONNECTED_PREFIX(ifc); + apply_mask (&cp); + /* Get address derived subnet node. */ - rn = route_node_lookup (zebra_if->ipv4_subnets, ifc->address); + rn = route_node_lookup (zebra_if->ipv4_subnets, &cp); if (! (rn && rn->info)) return -1; route_unlock_node (rn); @@ -588,8 +592,18 @@ connected_dump_vty (struct vty *vty, struct connected *connected) { vty_out (vty, (CONNECTED_PEER(connected) ? " peer " : " broadcast ")); prefix_vty_out (vty, connected->destination); + vty_out (vty, "/%d", connected->destination->prefixlen); } +#ifdef HAVE_NETLINK + if (connected->scope != 0) + vty_out (vty, " scope %s", connected_scope_name (connected->scope)); +#endif +#ifdef SIOCSIFADDRPREF + if (connected->preference != 0) + vty_out (vty, " preference %d", connected->preference); +#endif + if (CHECK_FLAG (connected->flags, ZEBRA_IFA_SECONDARY)) vty_out (vty, " secondary"); @@ -1149,21 +1163,62 @@ ALIAS (no_bandwidth_if, static int ip_address_install (struct vty *vty, struct interface *ifp, const char *addr_str, const char *peer_str, - const char *label) + const char *label, const char *scope, + const char *preference) { - struct prefix_ipv4 cp; + struct prefix_ipv4 lp, pp; struct connected *ifc; struct prefix_ipv4 *p; int ret; + int scopev = 0, preferencev = 0; - ret = str2prefix_ipv4 (addr_str, &cp); + ret = str2prefix_ipv4 (addr_str, &lp); if (ret <= 0) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Malformed address %s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } + + if (peer_str) { - vty_out (vty, "%% Malformed address %s", VTY_NEWLINE); - return CMD_WARNING; + if (lp.prefixlen != 32) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Local prefix length for P-t-P address " + "must be /32%s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } + + ret = str2prefix_ipv4 (peer_str, &pp); + if (ret <= 0) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Malformed peer address %s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } } - ifc = connected_check (ifp, (struct prefix *) &cp); +#ifdef HAVE_NETLINK + if (scope) + { + scopev = connected_scope_number (scope); + if (scopev < 0) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Malformed scope %s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } + } +#endif + if (preference) + { + preferencev = atoi (preference); + if (preferencev < -32768 || preferencev > 32767) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Invalid preference %s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } + } + + ifc = connected_check_ptp (ifp, (struct prefix *) &lp, + (struct prefix *)(peer_str ? &pp : NULL)); if (! ifc) { ifc = connected_new (); @@ -1171,14 +1226,23 @@ ip_address_install (struct vty *vty, struct interface *ifp, /* Address. */ p = prefix_ipv4_new (); - *p = cp; + *p = lp; ifc->address = (struct prefix *) p; + ifc->scope = scopev; + ifc->preference = preferencev; - /* Broadcast. */ - if (p->prefixlen <= IPV4_MAX_PREFIXLEN-2) + if (peer_str) { + SET_FLAG(ifc->flags, ZEBRA_IFA_PEER); p = prefix_ipv4_new (); - *p = cp; + *p = pp; + ifc->destination = (struct prefix *) p; + } + else if (p->prefixlen <= IPV4_MAX_PREFIXLEN-2) + { + /* Broadcast. */ + p = prefix_ipv4_new (); + *p = lp; p->prefix.s_addr = ipv4_broadcast_addr(p->prefix.s_addr,p->prefixlen); ifc->destination = (struct prefix *) p; } @@ -1233,23 +1297,40 @@ ip_address_install (struct vty *vty, struct interface *ifp, static int ip_address_uninstall (struct vty *vty, struct interface *ifp, - const char *addr_str, const char *peer_str, - const char *label) + const char *addr_str, const char *peer_str) { - struct prefix_ipv4 cp; + struct prefix_ipv4 lp, pp; struct connected *ifc; int ret; /* Convert to prefix structure. */ - ret = str2prefix_ipv4 (addr_str, &cp); + ret = str2prefix_ipv4 (addr_str, &lp); if (ret <= 0) { vty_out (vty, "%% Malformed address %s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; } + if (peer_str) + { + if (lp.prefixlen != 32) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Local prefix length for P-t-P address " + "must be /32%s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } + + ret = str2prefix_ipv4 (peer_str, &pp); + if (ret <= 0) + { + vty_out (vty, "%% Malformed peer address %s", VTY_NEWLINE); + return CMD_WARNING; + } + } + /* Check current interface address. */ - ifc = connected_check (ifp, (struct prefix *) &cp); + ifc = connected_check_ptp (ifp, (struct prefix *) &lp, + (struct prefix *)(peer_str ? &pp : NULL)); if (! ifc) { vty_out (vty, "%% Can't find address%s", VTY_NEWLINE); @@ -1279,70 +1360,169 @@ ip_address_uninstall (struct vty *vty, struct interface *ifp, safe_strerror(errno), VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; } + /* success! now update all internal state... */ + + /* Remove connected route. */ + connected_down_ipv4 (ifp, ifc); -#if 0 /* Redistribute this information. */ zebra_interface_address_delete_update (ifp, ifc); - /* Remove connected route. */ - connected_down_ipv4 (ifp, ifc); + /* IP address propery set. */ + UNSET_FLAG (ifc->conf, ZEBRA_IFC_REAL); + + /* remove from interface, remark secondaries */ + if_subnet_delete (ifp, ifc); /* Free address information. */ listnode_delete (ifp->connected, ifc); connected_free (ifc); -#endif return CMD_SUCCESS; } +#define IP_ADDR_STR \ + "Interface Internet Protocol config commands\n" \ + "Set the IP address of an interface\n" \ + "IP address (e.g. 10.0.0.1/8)\n" +#define IP_ADDR_PEER_STR \ + "Interface Internet Protocol config commands\n" \ + "Set the IP address of an interface\n" \ + "Local IP (e.g. 10.0.0.1) for P-t-P address\n" \ + "Specify P-t-P address\n" \ + "Peer IP address (e.g. 10.0.0.1/8)\n" + DEFUN (ip_address, ip_address_cmd, "ip address A.B.C.D/M", - "Interface Internet Protocol config commands\n" - "Set the IP address of an interface\n" - "IP address (e.g. 10.0.0.1/8)\n") + IP_ADDR_STR) { - return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, NULL); + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, + NULL, NULL, NULL); } DEFUN (no_ip_address, no_ip_address_cmd, "no ip address A.B.C.D/M", - NO_STR - "Interface Internet Protocol config commands\n" - "Set the IP address of an interface\n" - "IP Address (e.g. 10.0.0.1/8)") + NO_STR IP_ADDR_STR) { - return ip_address_uninstall (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, NULL); + return ip_address_uninstall (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL); +} + +DEFUN (ip_address_peer, + ip_address_peer_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D peer A.B.C.D/M", + IP_ADDR_PEER_STR) +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], argv[1], + NULL, NULL, NULL); +} + +DEFUN (no_ip_address_peer, + no_ip_address_peer_cmd, + "no ip address A.B.C.D peer A.B.C.D/M", + NO_STR IP_ADDR_PEER_STR) +{ + return ip_address_uninstall (vty, vty->index, argv[0], argv[1]); } #ifdef HAVE_NETLINK DEFUN (ip_address_label, ip_address_label_cmd, "ip address A.B.C.D/M label LINE", - "Interface Internet Protocol config commands\n" - "Set the IP address of an interface\n" - "IP address (e.g. 10.0.0.1/8)\n" + IP_ADDR_STR "Label of this address\n" "Label\n") { - return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, argv[1]); + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, + argv[1], NULL, NULL); } -DEFUN (no_ip_address_label, - no_ip_address_label_cmd, - "no ip address A.B.C.D/M label LINE", - NO_STR - "Interface Internet Protocol config commands\n" - "Set the IP address of an interface\n" - "IP address (e.g. 10.0.0.1/8)\n" +DEFUN (ip_address_peer_label, + ip_address_peer_label_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D peer A.B.C.D/M label LINE", + IP_ADDR_PEER_STR + "Label of this address\n" + "Label\n") +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], argv[1], + argv[2], NULL, NULL); +} + +DEFUN (ip_address_scope, + ip_address_scope_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D/M scope WORD", + IP_ADDR_STR + "Scope of this address\n" + "Scope (e.g. 0-255 or global,site,link,host,nowhere)\n") +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, + NULL, argv[1], NULL); +} + +DEFUN (ip_address_peer_scope, + ip_address_peer_scope_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D peer A.B.C.D/M scope WORD", + IP_ADDR_PEER_STR + "Scope of this address\n" + "Scope (e.g. 0-255 or global,site,link,host,nowhere)\n") +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], argv[1], + NULL, argv[2], NULL); +} + +DEFUN (ip_address_scope_label, + ip_address_scope_label_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D/M scope WORD label LINE", + IP_ADDR_STR + "Scope of this address\n" + "Scope (e.g. 0-255 or global,site,link,host,nowhere)\n" "Label of this address\n" "Label\n") { - return ip_address_uninstall (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, argv[1]); + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, + argv[2], argv[1], NULL); } + +DEFUN (ip_address_peer_scope_label, + ip_address_peer_scope_label_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D peer A.B.C.D/M scope WORD label LINE", + IP_ADDR_PEER_STR + "Scope of this address\n" + "Scope (e.g. 0-255 or global,site,link,host,nowhere)\n" + "Label of this address\n" + "Label\n") +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], argv[1], + argv[3], argv[2], NULL); +} + #endif /* HAVE_NETLINK */ +#ifdef SIOCSIFADDRPREF +DEFUN (ip_address_pref, + ip_address_pref_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D/M preference WORD", + IP_ADDR_STR + "specify IPSRCSEL preference\n" + "preference value, higher is preferred\n") +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], NULL, + NULL, NULL, argv[1]); +} + +DEFUN (ip_address_peer_pref, + ip_address_peer_pref_cmd, + "ip address A.B.C.D peer A.B.C.D/M preference WORD", + IP_ADDR_PEER_STR + "specify IPSRCSEL preference\n" + "preference value, higher is preferred\n") +{ + return ip_address_install (vty, vty->index, argv[0], argv[1], + NULL, NULL, argv[2]); +} +#endif + #ifdef HAVE_IPV6 static int ipv6_address_install (struct vty *vty, struct interface *ifp, @@ -1540,14 +1720,27 @@ if_config_write (struct vty *vty) { char buf[INET6_ADDRSTRLEN]; p = ifc->address; - vty_out (vty, " ip%s address %s/%d", + vty_out (vty, " ip%s address %s", p->family == AF_INET ? "" : "v6", - inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, sizeof(buf)), - p->prefixlen); + inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, sizeof(buf))); + if (CONNECTED_PEER (ifc)) + { + p = ifc->destination; + vty_out (vty, " peer %s", + inet_ntop (p->family, &p->u.prefix, buf, sizeof(buf))); + } + vty_out (vty, "/%d", p->prefixlen); +#ifdef HAVE_NETLINK + if (ifc->scope) + vty_out (vty, " scope %s", connected_scope_name (ifc->scope)); if (ifc->label) vty_out (vty, " label %s", ifc->label); - +#endif +#ifdef SIOCSIFADDRPREF + if (ifc->preference) + vty_out (vty, " preference %d", ifc->preference); +#endif vty_out (vty, "%s", VTY_NEWLINE); } } @@ -1607,12 +1800,22 @@ zebra_if_init (void) install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &no_bandwidth_if_val_cmd); install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_cmd); install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &no_ip_address_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_peer_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &no_ip_address_peer_cmd); #ifdef HAVE_IPV6 install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ipv6_address_cmd); install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &no_ipv6_address_cmd); #endif /* HAVE_IPV6 */ #ifdef HAVE_NETLINK install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_label_cmd); - install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &no_ip_address_label_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_scope_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_scope_label_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_peer_label_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_peer_scope_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_peer_scope_label_cmd); #endif /* HAVE_NETLINK */ +#ifdef SIOCSIFADDRPREF + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_pref_cmd); + install_element (INTERFACE_NODE, &ip_address_peer_pref_cmd); +#endif } diff --git a/zebra/ioctl.c b/zebra/ioctl.c index d783b0a3..6cb428a7 100644 --- a/zebra/ioctl.c +++ b/zebra/ioctl.c @@ -191,10 +191,16 @@ if_set_prefix (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) { int ret; struct ifaliasreq addreq; - struct sockaddr_in addr; - struct sockaddr_in mask; + struct sockaddr_in addr, mask, peer; struct prefix_ipv4 *p; + /* don't configure PtP addresses on broadcast ifs or reverse */ + if (!(ifp->flags & IFF_POINTOPOINT) != !CONNECTED_PEER (ifc)) + { + errno = EINVAL; + return -1; + } + p = (struct prefix_ipv4 *) ifc->address; rib_lookup_and_pushup (p); @@ -209,6 +215,18 @@ if_set_prefix (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) #endif memcpy (&addreq.ifra_addr, &addr, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + if (CONNECTED_PEER (ifc)) + { + p = (struct prefix_ipv4 *) ifc->destination; + memset (&mask, 0, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + peer.sin_addr = p->prefix; + peer.sin_family = p->family; +#ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_SOCKADDR_IN_SIN_LEN + peer.sin_len = sizeof (struct sockaddr_in); +#endif + memcpy (&addreq.ifra_broadaddr, &peer, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + } + memset (&mask, 0, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); masklen2ip (p->prefixlen, &mask.sin_addr); mask.sin_family = p->family; @@ -216,10 +234,27 @@ if_set_prefix (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) mask.sin_len = sizeof (struct sockaddr_in); #endif memcpy (&addreq.ifra_mask, &mask, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); - + ret = if_ioctl (SIOCAIFADDR, (caddr_t) &addreq); if (ret < 0) return ret; + +#ifdef SIOCSIFADDRPREF + if (ifc->preference != 0) + { + struct if_addrprefreq ifapr; + + memset (&ifapr, 0, sizeof ifapr); + strncpy ((char *)&ifapr.ifap_name, ifp->name, sizeof ifapr.ifap_name); + ifapr.ifap_preference = ifc->preference; + memcpy (&ifapr.ifap_addr, &addr, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + + ret = if_ioctl (SIOCSIFADDRPREF, (caddr_t) &ifapr); + if (ret < 0) + zlog_err("if_ioctl(SIOCSIFADDRPREF) failed: %s", + safe_strerror(errno)); + } +#endif return 0; } @@ -230,10 +265,16 @@ if_unset_prefix (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) { int ret; struct ifaliasreq addreq; - struct sockaddr_in addr; - struct sockaddr_in mask; + struct sockaddr_in addr, mask, peer; struct prefix_ipv4 *p; + /* this would probably wreak havoc */ + if (!(ifp->flags & IFF_POINTOPOINT) != !CONNECTED_PEER (ifc)) + { + errno = EINVAL; + return -1; + } + p = (struct prefix_ipv4 *)ifc->address; memset (&addreq, 0, sizeof addreq); @@ -247,6 +288,18 @@ if_unset_prefix (struct interface *ifp, struct connected *ifc) #endif memcpy (&addreq.ifra_addr, &addr, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + if (CONNECTED_PEER (ifc)) + { + p = (struct prefix_ipv4 *) ifc->destination; + memset (&mask, 0, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + peer.sin_addr = p->prefix; + peer.sin_family = p->family; +#ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_SOCKADDR_IN_SIN_LEN + peer.sin_len = sizeof (struct sockaddr_in); +#endif + memcpy (&addreq.ifra_broadaddr, &peer, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + } + memset (&mask, 0, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); masklen2ip (p->prefixlen, &mask.sin_addr); mask.sin_family = p->family; diff --git a/zebra/kernel_null.c b/zebra/kernel_null.c index 6b96c6df..f83c2345 100644 --- a/zebra/kernel_null.c +++ b/zebra/kernel_null.c @@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ int kernel_address_add_ipv4 (struct interface *a, struct connected *b) SET_FLAG (b->conf, ZEBRA_IFC_REAL); connected_add_ipv4 (a, 0, &b->address->u.prefix4, b->address->prefixlen, (b->destination ? &b->destination->u.prefix4 : NULL), - NULL); + NULL, 0, 0); return 0; } diff --git a/zebra/kernel_socket.c b/zebra/kernel_socket.c index feeaf5d0..aa962a35 100644 --- a/zebra/kernel_socket.c +++ b/zebra/kernel_socket.c @@ -253,6 +253,25 @@ rtm_flag_dump (int flag) zlog_debug ("Kernel: %s", buf); } +/* NetBSD IPSRCSEL preference readback */ +static int +if_get_addrpref (const char *ifname, struct sockaddr_in *addr) +{ +#ifdef SIOCSIFADDRPREF + int ret; + struct if_addrprefreq ifapr; + + memset (&ifapr, 0, sizeof ifapr); + strncpy ((char *)&ifapr.ifap_name, ifname, sizeof ifapr.ifap_name); + memcpy (&ifapr.ifap_addr, addr, sizeof (struct sockaddr_in)); + + ret = if_ioctl (SIOCGIFADDRPREF, (caddr_t) &ifapr); + if (ret == 0) + return ifapr.ifap_preference; +#endif + return 0; +} + #ifdef RTM_IFANNOUNCE /* Interface adding function */ static int @@ -619,6 +638,7 @@ ifam_read (struct ifa_msghdr *ifam) short ifnlen = 0; char isalias = 0; int flags = 0; + int preference = 0; ifname[0] = ifname[INTERFACE_NAMSIZ - 1] = '\0'; @@ -649,6 +669,9 @@ ifam_read (struct ifa_msghdr *ifam) */ ifp->metric = ifam->ifam_metric; #endif + if (sockunion_family (&addr) == AF_INET + && ifam->ifam_type == RTM_NEWADDR) + preference = if_get_addrpref (ifp->name, &addr.sin); /* Add connected address. */ switch (sockunion_family (&addr)) @@ -658,7 +681,7 @@ ifam_read (struct ifa_msghdr *ifam) connected_add_ipv4 (ifp, flags, &addr.sin.sin_addr, ip_masklen (mask.sin.sin_addr), &brd.sin.sin_addr, - (isalias ? ifname : NULL)); + (isalias ? ifname : NULL), 0, preference); else connected_delete_ipv4 (ifp, flags, &addr.sin.sin_addr, ip_masklen (mask.sin.sin_addr), @@ -675,7 +698,7 @@ ifam_read (struct ifa_msghdr *ifam) connected_add_ipv6 (ifp, flags, &addr.sin6.sin6_addr, ip6_masklen (mask.sin6.sin6_addr), &brd.sin6.sin6_addr, - (isalias ? ifname : NULL)); + (isalias ? ifname : NULL), 0); else connected_delete_ipv6 (ifp, &addr.sin6.sin6_addr, diff --git a/zebra/main.c b/zebra/main.c index d829c046..b58fed12 100644 --- a/zebra/main.c +++ b/zebra/main.c @@ -32,6 +32,7 @@ #include "plist.h" #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "zebra/rib.h" #include "zebra/zserv.h" @@ -68,6 +69,7 @@ struct option longopts[] = { { "batch", no_argument, NULL, 'b'}, { "daemon", no_argument, NULL, 'd'}, + { "namespace", required_argument, NULL, 'N'}, { "keep_kernel", no_argument, NULL, 'k'}, { "config_file", required_argument, NULL, 'f'}, { "pid_file", required_argument, NULL, 'i'}, @@ -108,10 +110,13 @@ struct zebra_privs_t zserv_privs = }; /* Default configuration file path. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR DEFAULT_CONFIG_FILE; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_ZEBRA_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* Help information display. */ static void @@ -126,6 +131,7 @@ usage (char *progname, int status) "redistribution between different routing protocols.\n\n"\ "-b, --batch Runs in batch mode\n"\ "-d, --daemon Runs in daemon mode\n"\ + "-N, --namespace Insert argument into all paths\n"\ "-f, --config_file Set configuration file name\n"\ "-i, --pid_file Set process identifier file name\n"\ "-k, --keep_kernel Don't delete old routes which installed by "\ @@ -229,9 +235,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) int opt; #ifdef HAVE_NETLINK - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "bdkf:i:hA:P:ru:g:vs:C", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "bdN:kf:i:hA:P:ru:g:vs:C", longopts, 0); #else - opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "bdkf:i:hA:P:ru:g:vC", longopts, 0); + opt = getopt_long (argc, argv, "bdN:kf:i:hA:P:ru:g:vC", longopts, 0); #endif /* HAVE_NETLINK */ if (opt == EOF) @@ -246,6 +252,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) case 'd': daemon_mode = 1; break; + case 'N': + path_set_namespace (optarg); + break; case 'k': keep_kernel_mode = 1; break; @@ -300,6 +309,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) } } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (ZEBRA_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (ZEBRA_PID_NAME)); + /* Make master thread emulator. */ zebrad.master = thread_master_create (); @@ -389,7 +401,7 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) zebra_zserv_socket_init (); /* Make vty server socket. */ - vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, ZEBRA_VTYSH_PATH); + vty_serv_sock (vty_addr, vty_port, path_state (ZEBRA_VTY_NAME)); /* Print banner. */ zlog_notice ("Zebra %s starting: vty@%d", QUAGGA_VERSION, vty_port); diff --git a/zebra/redistribute.c b/zebra/redistribute.c index a8107aeb..4276f1d0 100644 --- a/zebra/redistribute.c +++ b/zebra/redistribute.c @@ -245,26 +245,15 @@ zebra_redistribute_add (int command, struct zserv *client, int length) type = stream_getc (client->ibuf); - switch (type) + if (type == 0 || type >= ZEBRA_ROUTE_MAX) + return; + + if (! client->redist[type]) { - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP: - if (! client->redist[type]) - { - client->redist[type] = 1; - zebra_redistribute (client, type); - } - break; - default: - break; + client->redist[type] = 1; + zebra_redistribute (client, type); } -} +} void zebra_redistribute_delete (int command, struct zserv *client, int length) @@ -273,22 +262,11 @@ zebra_redistribute_delete (int command, struct zserv *client, int length) type = stream_getc (client->ibuf); - switch (type) - { - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6: - case ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP: - client->redist[type] = 0; - break; - default: - break; - } -} + if (type == 0 || type >= ZEBRA_ROUTE_MAX) + return; + + client->redist[type] = 0; +} void zebra_redistribute_default_add (int command, struct zserv *client, int length) diff --git a/zebra/rt_netlink.c b/zebra/rt_netlink.c index 7652f80a..d25543ff 100644 --- a/zebra/rt_netlink.c +++ b/zebra/rt_netlink.c @@ -549,6 +549,7 @@ netlink_interface_addr (struct sockaddr_nl *snl, struct nlmsghdr *h) char buf[BUFSIZ]; zlog_debug ("netlink_interface_addr %s %s:", lookup (nlmsg_str, h->nlmsg_type), ifp->name); + zlog_debug (" ifa_scope %s", connected_scope_name (ifa->ifa_scope)); if (tb[IFA_LOCAL]) zlog_debug (" IFA_LOCAL %s/%d", inet_ntop (ifa->ifa_family, RTA_DATA (tb[IFA_LOCAL]), @@ -616,7 +617,7 @@ netlink_interface_addr (struct sockaddr_nl *snl, struct nlmsghdr *h) if (h->nlmsg_type == RTM_NEWADDR) connected_add_ipv4 (ifp, flags, (struct in_addr *) addr, ifa->ifa_prefixlen, - (struct in_addr *) broad, label); + (struct in_addr *) broad, label, ifa->ifa_scope, 0); else connected_delete_ipv4 (ifp, flags, (struct in_addr *) addr, ifa->ifa_prefixlen, @@ -628,7 +629,7 @@ netlink_interface_addr (struct sockaddr_nl *snl, struct nlmsghdr *h) if (h->nlmsg_type == RTM_NEWADDR) connected_add_ipv6 (ifp, flags, (struct in6_addr *) addr, ifa->ifa_prefixlen, - (struct in6_addr *) broad, label); + (struct in6_addr *) broad, label, ifa->ifa_scope); else connected_delete_ipv6 (ifp, (struct in6_addr *) addr, ifa->ifa_prefixlen, @@ -1778,20 +1779,30 @@ netlink_address (int cmd, int family, struct interface *ifp, req.ifa.ifa_family = family; req.ifa.ifa_index = ifp->ifindex; - req.ifa.ifa_prefixlen = p->prefixlen; + req.ifa.ifa_scope = ifc->scope; addattr_l (&req.n, sizeof req, IFA_LOCAL, &p->u.prefix, bytelen); - if (family == AF_INET && cmd == RTM_NEWADDR) + if (family == AF_INET) { - if (!CONNECTED_PEER(ifc) && ifc->destination) + if (CONNECTED_PEER(ifc)) { p = ifc->destination; - addattr_l (&req.n, sizeof req, IFA_BROADCAST, &p->u.prefix, + addattr_l (&req.n, sizeof req, IFA_ADDRESS, &p->u.prefix, bytelen); } + else + if (cmd == RTM_NEWADDR && ifc->destination) + { + p = ifc->destination; + addattr_l (&req.n, sizeof req, IFA_BROADCAST, &p->u.prefix, + bytelen); + } } + /* p is now either ifc->address or ifc->destination */ + req.ifa.ifa_prefixlen = p->prefixlen; + if (CHECK_FLAG (ifc->flags, ZEBRA_IFA_SECONDARY)) SET_FLAG (req.ifa.ifa_flags, IFA_F_SECONDARY); diff --git a/zebra/test_main.c b/zebra/test_main.c index 70a1a3a6..4e1002e8 100644 --- a/zebra/test_main.c +++ b/zebra/test_main.c @@ -29,6 +29,7 @@ #include "log.h" #include "privs.h" #include "sigevent.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "zebra/rib.h" #include "zebra/zserv.h" @@ -73,10 +74,13 @@ zebra_capabilities_t _caps_p [] = }; /* Default configuration file path. */ -char config_default[] = SYSCONFDIR DEFAULT_CONFIG_FILE; +char config_default[MAXPATHLEN]; + +/* pid_file default value */ +static char pid_file_default[MAXPATHLEN]; /* Process ID saved for use by init system */ -const char *pid_file = PATH_ZEBRA_PID; +const char *pid_file = pid_file_default; /* Help information display. */ static void @@ -276,6 +280,9 @@ main (int argc, char **argv) usage (progname, 1); } + strcpy (config_default, path_config (ZEBRA_CONFIG_NAME)); + strcpy (pid_file_default, path_state (ZEBRA_PID_NAME)); + /* Make master thread emulator. */ zebrad.master = thread_master_create (); diff --git a/zebra/zebra_rib.c b/zebra/zebra_rib.c index 12f3fa5a..7374f73d 100644 --- a/zebra/zebra_rib.c +++ b/zebra/zebra_rib.c @@ -67,6 +67,7 @@ static const struct {ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6, 110}, {ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS, 115}, {ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP, 20 /* IBGP is 200. */} + /* no entry/default: 150 */ }; /* Vector for routing table. */ @@ -365,7 +366,8 @@ nexthop_active_ipv4 (struct rib *rib, struct nexthop *nexthop, int set, } else { - if (match->type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT) + if (match->type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT + || (match->nexthop && match->nexthop->type == NEXTHOP_TYPE_IFINDEX)) { /* Directly point connected route. */ newhop = match->nexthop; @@ -1511,7 +1513,10 @@ rib_add_ipv4 (int type, int flags, struct prefix_ipv4 *p, /* Set default distance by route type. */ if (distance == 0) { - distance = route_info[type].distance; + if ((unsigned)type >= sizeof(route_info) / sizeof(route_info[0])) + distance = 150; + else + distance = route_info[type].distance; /* iBGP distance is 200. */ if (type == ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP && CHECK_FLAG (flags, ZEBRA_FLAG_IBGP)) diff --git a/zebra/zebra_vty.c b/zebra/zebra_vty.c index ecb5d10a..05485a13 100644 --- a/zebra/zebra_vty.c +++ b/zebra/zebra_vty.c @@ -802,10 +802,6 @@ vty_show_ip_route (struct vty *vty, struct route_node *rn, struct rib *rib) } } -#define SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER "Codes: K - kernel route, C - connected, " \ - "S - static, R - RIP, O - OSPF,%s I - ISIS, B - BGP, " \ - "> - selected route, * - FIB route%s%s" - DEFUN (show_ip_route, show_ip_route_cmd, "show ip route", @@ -828,8 +824,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ip_route, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE, - VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ip_route (vty, rn, rib); @@ -871,8 +866,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ip_route_prefix_longer, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER, VTY_NEWLINE, - VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ip_route (vty, rn, rib); @@ -910,8 +904,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ip_route_supernets, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER, VTY_NEWLINE, - VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ip_route (vty, rn, rib); @@ -922,17 +915,11 @@ DEFUN (show_ip_route_supernets, DEFUN (show_ip_route_protocol, show_ip_route_protocol_cmd, - "show ip route (bgp|connected|isis|kernel|ospf|rip|static)", + "show ip route " QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_STR_ZEBRA, SHOW_STR IP_STR "IP routing table\n" - "Border Gateway Protocol (BGP)\n" - "Connected\n" - "ISO IS-IS (ISIS)\n" - "Kernel\n" - "Open Shortest Path First (OSPF)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIP)\n" - "Static routes\n") + QUAGGA_IP_REDIST_HELP_STR_ZEBRA) { int type; struct route_table *table; @@ -940,21 +927,8 @@ DEFUN (show_ip_route_protocol, struct rib *rib; int first = 1; - if (strncmp (argv[0], "b", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "c", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "k", 1) ==0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "o", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "i", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "r", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIP; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "s", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP, argv[0]); + if (type < 0) { vty_out (vty, "Unknown route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -971,8 +945,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ip_route_protocol, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER, - VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V4_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ip_route (vty, rn, rib); @@ -1766,8 +1739,6 @@ vty_show_ipv6_route (struct vty *vty, struct route_node *rn, } } -#define SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER "Codes: K - kernel route, C - connected, S - static, R - RIPng, O - OSPFv3,%s I - ISIS, B - BGP, * - FIB route.%s%s" - DEFUN (show_ipv6_route, show_ipv6_route_cmd, "show ipv6 route", @@ -1790,7 +1761,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ipv6_route, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ipv6_route (vty, rn, rib); @@ -1832,7 +1803,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ipv6_route_prefix_longer, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ipv6_route (vty, rn, rib); @@ -1842,17 +1813,11 @@ DEFUN (show_ipv6_route_prefix_longer, DEFUN (show_ipv6_route_protocol, show_ipv6_route_protocol_cmd, - "show ipv6 route (bgp|connected|isis|kernel|ospf6|ripng|static)", + "show ipv6 route " QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_STR_ZEBRA, SHOW_STR IP_STR "IP routing table\n" - "Border Gateway Protocol (BGP)\n" - "Connected\n" - "ISO IS-IS (ISIS)\n" - "Kernel\n" - "Open Shortest Path First (OSPFv3)\n" - "Routing Information Protocol (RIPng)\n" - "Static routes\n") + QUAGGA_IP6_REDIST_HELP_STR_ZEBRA) { int type; struct route_table *table; @@ -1860,21 +1825,8 @@ DEFUN (show_ipv6_route_protocol, struct rib *rib; int first = 1; - if (strncmp (argv[0], "b", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_BGP; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "c", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_CONNECT; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "k", 1) ==0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_KERNEL; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "o", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_OSPF6; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "i", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_ISIS; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "r", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_RIPNG; - else if (strncmp (argv[0], "s", 1) == 0) - type = ZEBRA_ROUTE_STATIC; - else + type = proto_redistnum (AFI_IP6, argv[0]); + if (type < 0) { vty_out (vty, "Unknown route type%s", VTY_NEWLINE); return CMD_WARNING; @@ -1891,7 +1843,7 @@ DEFUN (show_ipv6_route_protocol, { if (first) { - vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE, VTY_NEWLINE); + vty_out (vty, SHOW_ROUTE_V6_HEADER); first = 0; } vty_show_ipv6_route (vty, rn, rib); diff --git a/zebra/zserv.c b/zebra/zserv.c index cb5e411c..e3e15a01 100644 --- a/zebra/zserv.c +++ b/zebra/zserv.c @@ -36,6 +36,7 @@ #include "privs.h" #include "network.h" #include "buffer.h" +#include "paths.h" #include "zebra/zserv.h" #include "zebra/router-id.h" @@ -1738,6 +1739,6 @@ zebra_zserv_socket_init (void) #ifdef HAVE_TCP_ZEBRA zebra_serv (); #else - zebra_serv_un (ZEBRA_SERV_PATH); + zebra_serv_un (path_state (ZEBRA_SERV_NAME)); #endif /* HAVE_TCP_ZEBRA */ } diff --git a/zebra/zserv.h b/zebra/zserv.h index a7371830..cccd9be0 100644 --- a/zebra/zserv.h +++ b/zebra/zserv.h @@ -30,7 +30,9 @@ #define ZEBRA_VTY_PORT 2601 /* Default configuration filename. */ -#define DEFAULT_CONFIG_FILE "zebra.conf" +#define ZEBRA_CONFIG_NAME "zebra.conf" +#define ZEBRA_PID_NAME "zebra.pid" +#define ZEBRA_VTY_NAME "zebra.vty" /* Client structure. */ struct zserv |